WO2020035041A1 - 一种显示控制方法及设备 - Google Patents

一种显示控制方法及设备 Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2020035041A1
WO2020035041A1 PCT/CN2019/100907 CN2019100907W WO2020035041A1 WO 2020035041 A1 WO2020035041 A1 WO 2020035041A1 CN 2019100907 W CN2019100907 W CN 2019100907W WO 2020035041 A1 WO2020035041 A1 WO 2020035041A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
information
frequency
cell
communication system
network icon
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/CN2019/100907
Other languages
English (en)
French (fr)
Inventor
姚楚婷
王键
刘海涛
Original Assignee
华为技术有限公司
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by 华为技术有限公司 filed Critical 华为技术有限公司
Publication of WO2020035041A1 publication Critical patent/WO2020035041A1/zh

Links

Images

Classifications

    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04MTELEPHONIC COMMUNICATION
    • H04M1/00Substation equipment, e.g. for use by subscribers
    • H04M1/72Mobile telephones; Cordless telephones, i.e. devices for establishing wireless links to base stations without route selection
    • H04M1/724User interfaces specially adapted for cordless or mobile telephones
    • H04M1/72448User interfaces specially adapted for cordless or mobile telephones with means for adapting the functionality of the device according to specific conditions
    • H04M1/72454User interfaces specially adapted for cordless or mobile telephones with means for adapting the functionality of the device according to specific conditions according to context-related or environment-related conditions
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/30Monitoring
    • G06F11/32Monitoring with visual or acoustical indication of the functioning of the machine
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/30Monitoring
    • G06F11/32Monitoring with visual or acoustical indication of the functioning of the machine
    • G06F11/324Display of status information
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F3/00Input arrangements for transferring data to be processed into a form capable of being handled by the computer; Output arrangements for transferring data from processing unit to output unit, e.g. interface arrangements
    • G06F3/01Input arrangements or combined input and output arrangements for interaction between user and computer
    • G06F3/048Interaction techniques based on graphical user interfaces [GUI]
    • G06F3/0481Interaction techniques based on graphical user interfaces [GUI] based on specific properties of the displayed interaction object or a metaphor-based environment, e.g. interaction with desktop elements like windows or icons, or assisted by a cursor's changing behaviour or appearance
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F3/00Input arrangements for transferring data to be processed into a form capable of being handled by the computer; Output arrangements for transferring data from processing unit to output unit, e.g. interface arrangements
    • G06F3/01Input arrangements or combined input and output arrangements for interaction between user and computer
    • G06F3/048Interaction techniques based on graphical user interfaces [GUI]
    • G06F3/0481Interaction techniques based on graphical user interfaces [GUI] based on specific properties of the displayed interaction object or a metaphor-based environment, e.g. interaction with desktop elements like windows or icons, or assisted by a cursor's changing behaviour or appearance
    • G06F3/04817Interaction techniques based on graphical user interfaces [GUI] based on specific properties of the displayed interaction object or a metaphor-based environment, e.g. interaction with desktop elements like windows or icons, or assisted by a cursor's changing behaviour or appearance using icons
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04MTELEPHONIC COMMUNICATION
    • H04M1/00Substation equipment, e.g. for use by subscribers
    • H04M1/72Mobile telephones; Cordless telephones, i.e. devices for establishing wireless links to base stations without route selection
    • H04M1/725Cordless telephones
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02DCLIMATE CHANGE MITIGATION TECHNOLOGIES IN INFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGIES [ICT], I.E. INFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGIES AIMING AT THE REDUCTION OF THEIR OWN ENERGY USE
    • Y02D30/00Reducing energy consumption in communication networks
    • Y02D30/70Reducing energy consumption in communication networks in wireless communication networks

Definitions

  • the embodiments of the present application relate to the field of communications technologies, and in particular, to a display control method and device. .
  • the terminal After the terminal is powered on, it registers the mobile communication network by exchanging attachment information with the core network of the mobile communication network. After the network registration is successful, the terminal resides or works under the registered network, and the icon of the registered network is displayed in the status bar. If the registered network has not changed, the network icon displayed by the terminal will not change; the terminal displays the icon of the other network only after the registered network grid terminal is re-registered to another network.
  • the terminal when the terminal is registered to the 4th generation mobile communication technology (4G) network, the terminal may display a "4G" icon in the status bar. Until the 4G network is disconnected, the terminal keeps displaying the "4G” icon. After the 4G network is disconnected, the terminal falls back to the 3rd-generation mobile communication technology (3G) network, and the terminal updates the "4G" icon to the "3G” icon.
  • 4G 4th generation mobile communication technology
  • the embodiments of the present application provide a display control method and device, which can flexibly display network icons.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides a display control method, including: a first device acquiring mapping information, where the mapping information includes multiple correspondences, and the multiple correspondences are used to represent n first parameter information and multiple networks Correspondence of icons, n is a positive integer, the first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, service type, operator information, location information, connection status information, or scene information, and connection status information includes idle, inactive, and inactive Or connected state.
  • the first device acquires m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working state of the first device, where m is a positive integer less than or equal to n.
  • the first device displays a network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon.
  • the first device may dynamically display different network icons according to different first parameter information obtained from the second device or according to the working status of the first device, unlike the prior art. That way, only the icon of the network registered by the first device can be kept displayed, so that the display of the network icon can be flexibly controlled, which more conveniently meets the operation and maintenance requirements of the operator.
  • the scenario information includes: a first working scenario, and a cell where the first device is located is a cell of the first communication system and supports cooperation with the second communication system. Networking; or, in the second working scenario, the first device registers with the core network of the second communication system through the air interface of the first communication system; or, in the third working scenario, the cell where the first device is located is the cell of the second communication system Or, in a fourth working scenario, the first device is connected to a base station of the first communication system, and the first device has a secondary base station of the second communication system.
  • the third working scenario includes: a serving cell when the first device is in a connected state is a cell of the second communication system; or a residential cell when the first device is in an idle or inactive state is a cell of the second communication system .
  • the first device may display different network icons.
  • the working status of the first device includes: a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located, and a The frequency of signals of neighboring cells, the service currently used by the first device, the operator currently used by the first device, the current location of the first device, the current connection status of the first device, or the current status of the first device The scene in which you work.
  • the first device can obtain the first parameter information according to the current working state of the first device.
  • the indication information is broadcast information received by the first device from the second device.
  • the first device can acquire the instruction information according to the broadcast information received from the second device, and thus control the display of the network icon according to the instruction information.
  • the operator information includes a public land mobile network (PLMN) identity.
  • PLMN public land mobile network
  • the first device can control the display of the network icon according to the PLMN identification.
  • the location information includes a country code, a province code, or a global positioning system (GPS) At least one of the messages.
  • GPS global positioning system
  • the first device can control the display of the network icon according to the country code, province code, or GPS information of the global positioning system.
  • the service types include carrier aggregation (CA) services, dual connectivity (DC) ) Services or at least one of multiple input multiple output (MIMO) services.
  • CA carrier aggregation
  • DC dual connectivity
  • MIMO multiple input multiple output
  • the first device may display different network icons according to different types of services used by the first device.
  • the first device acquiring mapping information includes: the first device acquiring a pre-made mapping on the first device Information; or, the first device obtains mapping information from a third device, and the third device is different from the second device.
  • the first device may obtain preset mapping information from the first device itself or from a third device.
  • obtaining, by the first device, pre-made mapping information on the first device includes: the first device obtaining the first device's Pre-made mapping information in a subscriber identity module (SIM) card; or, obtaining pre-made mapping information in the memory of the first device.
  • SIM subscriber identity module
  • mapping information may be set in a SIM card or a memory of the first device in advance.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information and frequency information, the indication The information is used to indicate whether to display the network icon of the second communication system; the frequency information is used to indicate whether the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the first device acquires m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working status of the first device, including: the first device receives instruction information from the second device; the first device is based on the service of the cell where the first device is located Frequency to obtain frequency information.
  • the first device displaying the network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon includes: if the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal , The first device displays the first network icon of the second communication system; if the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is not a high-frequency signal, the first device displays Second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first device may search for the corresponding target network icon from the mapping information according to the acquired instruction information and frequency information, thereby displaying the target network icon.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and scene information, and the frequency The information is used to indicate whether the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the first device obtains m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working status of the first device, including: the first device obtains frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located; the first device obtains frequency information according to the first device; Obtain scene information about the current working scene of the device.
  • the first device displaying a network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon includes: when the scenario information is the third working scenario or the fourth working scenario, if the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is High-frequency signals, the first device displays a first network icon of the second communication system. If the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is not a high-frequency signal, the first device displays a second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first device may search for the corresponding target network icon from the mapping information according to the acquired frequency information and scene information, thereby displaying the target network icon.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and scene information
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system with the operator.
  • the frequency of the frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the first device acquires m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working status of the first device, including: the first device according to the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located and the neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located The frequency of the signal is used to obtain frequency information; the first device obtains scene information according to the working scene in which the first device is currently located.
  • the first device displaying a network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon includes: when the scenario information is a third working scenario, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, if the frequency information Indicates that the first device is covered by high-frequency signals of a neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the first device displays a first network icon; if the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have a neighbor of the second communication system and the operator The high-frequency signal of the cell is covered, and the first device displays a second network icon.
  • the first device may search for the corresponding target network icon from the mapping information according to the acquired frequency information and scene information, thereby displaying the target network icon.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and connection status information
  • frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low frequency signal, and whether the first device is covered by the high frequency signal of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator. Set the value. The frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the first device acquires m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working status of the first device, including: the first device according to the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located and the neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located.
  • the frequency of the signal acquires frequency information; the first device acquires connection status information according to the current connection status; the first device acquires scene information according to the working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the first device displays a network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon, including: when the scenario information is a third working scenario, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, if the connection status If the information is idle or inactive, and the frequency information indicates that the first device is covered by the high frequency signal of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, the first device displays a third network icon; if the connection status information is connected State, and the frequency information indicates that the first device is covered by a high frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the first device displays a fourth network icon; if the connection state information is idle or inactive, and The frequency information indicates that the first device does not have high frequency signal coverage in the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the first device displays a fifth network icon; if the connection status information is connected, and the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have The second communication system covers the high-frequency signal of the
  • the first device may search for the corresponding target network icon from the mapping information according to the obtained frequency information, connection status information, and scene information, so as to display the target network icon.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, and Scene information
  • the indication information is used to indicate whether to display the network icon of the second communication system
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device has a second communication system related to the operator
  • the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell is covered, the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than a preset value, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the first device acquires m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working status of the first device, including: the first device receives instruction information from the second device; the first device is based on the service of the cell where the first device is located The frequency and the frequency of the signals of the neighboring cells of the cell where the first device is located acquire frequency information; the first device obtains scene information according to the working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the first device displaying the network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon includes: when the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, the scene information is the first working scene or the second working scene, and the frequency information
  • the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal
  • the first device displays the A network icon; if the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have high frequency signal coverage of the second communication system and an adjacent cell of the operator, the first device displays a second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first device may search for the corresponding target network icon from the mapping information according to the acquired instruction information, frequency information, and scene information, thereby displaying the target network icon.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, Connection status information and scene information, the indication information is used to indicate whether to display the network icon of the second communication system; the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device has The high-frequency signal coverage of the neighboring cell of the operator, the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than the preset value, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the first device acquires m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working status of the first device, including: the first device receives instruction information from the second device; the first device is based on the service of the cell where the first device is located The frequency and the frequency of the signal of the neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located obtain frequency information; the first device obtains connection status information according to the current connection status; the first device obtains scene information according to the working scenario where the first device is currently located .
  • the first device displaying a network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon includes: when the scene information is the first working scene or the second working scene, the indication information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, and the frequency information
  • the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal
  • the status information is idle or inactive
  • the frequency information indicates that the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator
  • the first device displays a seventh network icon of the second communication system; if the status information is idle or inactive, and the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have high-frequency signal coverage in the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator
  • the first device displays an eighth network icon of the second communication system; if the status information is connected and the frequency information indicates that the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the first device A device displays a ninth network icon of the second communication
  • the first device may search for the corresponding target network icon from the mapping information according to the acquired instruction information, frequency information, connection status information, and scene information, thereby displaying the target network icon.
  • the method before the first device acquires frequency information, the method further includes : The first device acquires detection information, the detection information includes second parameter information, and the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal of an adjacent cell; the first device measures the adjacent cell according to the detection information signal of.
  • the first device controls the display of the network icon, it can directly measure the signals of the neighboring cells according to the measurement information of the neighboring cells of the cell where the first device is located in the acquired detection information, without first searching through blind search.
  • the signal measurement is performed after measuring information such as the frequency of the neighboring cell, so that the time and power consumption of the first device in the full frequency search can be saved, and the working time of the first device can be prolonged.
  • the first device may intermittently measure signals of neighboring cells according to the time information in the acquired detection information, without performing real-time and continuous measurement, so that the power consumption of the first device may be further reduced.
  • the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of a cell of the second communication system. And / or, at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal in a neighboring cell of a cell where the first device is located, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the first device acquiring the detection information includes: the first device acquiring the first device Pre-made detection information; or, the first device acquires detection information from a third device.
  • the first device can directly measure the signal of the neighboring cell according to the measurement information or time information of the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell acquired from the first device or the third device.
  • the detection information further includes second parameter information and at least one first Correspondence between three parameter information, the third parameter information includes operator information or location information.
  • the first device can measure signals of the neighboring cells according to different measurement information or time information of neighboring cells corresponding to different operator information or location information.
  • the measurement information includes frequency information or cell information of a cell.
  • the first device can measure signals of the neighboring cell according to the frequency information or the cell information of the measurement information of the neighboring cell.
  • the time information is period information for the first device to measure
  • the period information is the interval between the start time of the first measurement and the start time of the second measurement when the first device performs two adjacent measurements, or the end time of the first measurement and the start time of the second measurement. Interval; or the interval between the end time of the first measurement and the end time of the second measurement.
  • the first device can measure signals of neighboring cells according to the periodic information in the detection information.
  • time information is applied to a timer, and time information is used to At least one of the following: time information is used by the first device to measure and start or restart the timer when the timer expires; or time information is used to start or restart the timer when the first device ends the measurement; or, time The information is used by the first device to reset or stop or cancel the timer when a cell reselection occurs; or, the time information is used to start the timer after the first device receives the second message sent by the second device; or, The time information is used by the first device to measure after receiving the second message sent by the second device, and to start or restart the timer when starting the measurement, or to start or restart the timer when ending the measurement.
  • the first device can measure signals of neighboring cells according to the timer information in the detection information.
  • the m first parameter information includes service type and scenario information
  • the first device obtains m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working status of the first device, including: the first device obtains a service type according to the service currently used by the first device; A device's current working scenario obtains scene information; the first device displays a network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon, including: when the scene information is the third working scenario, if the service type is carrier aggregation For CA services, the first device displays the eleventh network icon; if the service type is dual-connected DC service, the first device displays the twelfth network icon; if the service type is multiple-input multiple-output MIMO service, the first device displays The thirteenth network icon; otherwise, the first device displays a fourteenth network icon.
  • the first device may search for the corresponding target network icon from the mapping information according to the obtained scene information and service type, thereby displaying the target network icon.
  • m first parameter information includes scene information
  • the first The device acquires m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working status of the first device, including: the first device obtains scene information according to a working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the first device displaying the network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon includes: when the scene information is the second working scene, the first device displaying a second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first device may search for the corresponding target network icon from the mapping information according to the obtained scene information, thereby displaying the target network icon.
  • the first communication system is a 4G system
  • the second communication system is (5th-generation mobile communication technology (5G) system.
  • the first device can display the network icon of the 5G system or the network icon of the 4G system.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides a measurement method, including: the first device acquires detection information, the detection information includes second parameter information, and the second parameter information includes measurement information of a neighboring cell of a cell where the first device is located or At least one of time information.
  • the first device measures signals of neighboring cells according to the detection information.
  • the first device can directly measure the signals of the neighboring cells based on the measurement information of the neighboring cells of the cell where the first device is located in the acquired detection information, without first searching for the frequencies of the neighboring cells through blind search.
  • the signal measurement is performed after waiting for the measurement information, so the time and power consumption of the first device in the full frequency search can be saved, and the working time of the first device can be prolonged.
  • the first device may intermittently measure signals of neighboring cells according to the time information in the acquired detection information, without performing real-time and continuous measurement, so that the power consumption of the first device may be further reduced.
  • the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of neighboring cells in the target communication system; and / or, the target communication system In at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal of an adjacent cell, the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • obtaining the detection information by the first device includes: obtaining, by the first device, a prefabricated device on the first device. Detection information; or, the first device acquires detection information from a third device.
  • the detection information further includes a correspondence between the second parameter information and at least one third parameter information, and the third The parameter information includes operator information or location information.
  • the operator information includes a public land mobile network PLMN identification; the location information includes a country code or a province or city code or At least one of GPS positioning information.
  • the measurement information includes cell frequency information or cell information.
  • the time information is periodic information measured by the first device, and the periodic information is adjacent to the first device.
  • time information is applied to a timer, and time information is used for at least one of the following: time information is used for the first A device measures when the timer expires, and starts or restarts the timer; or, the time information is used to start or restart the timer when the first device ends the measurement; or, the time information is used when the first device acquires the detection After the information, the timer is started; or, the time information is used by the first device to measure after acquiring the information, and to start or restart the timer when the measurement starts, or to start or restart the timer when the measurement ends.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides a first device, including: a first obtaining unit, configured to obtain mapping information, where the mapping information includes multiple correspondences, and the multiple correspondences are used to represent n first parameter information Correspondence with multiple network icons, n is a positive integer, the first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, service type, operator information, location information, connection status information, or scene information, and connection status information includes idle status, Inactive or connected.
  • the second obtaining unit is configured to obtain m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working state of the first device, where m is a positive integer less than or equal to n.
  • the display unit is configured to display a network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon.
  • the scenario information includes: a first working scenario, and a cell where the first device is located is a cell of the first communication system and supports cooperation with the second communication system. Networking; or, in the second working scenario, the first device is registered with the core network of the second communication system through the air interface of the first communication system; or, in the third working scenario, the cell where the first device is located is the cell of the second communication system Or, in a fourth working scenario, the first device is connected to a base station of the first communication system, and the first device has a secondary base station of the second communication system.
  • the third working scenario includes: a serving cell when the first device is in a connected state is a cell of the second communication system; or a residential cell when the first device is in an idle or inactive state is a cell of the second communication system .
  • the working status of the first device includes: a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located, and a The frequency of signals of neighboring cells, the service currently used by the first device, the operator currently used by the first device, the current location of the first device, the current connection status of the first device, or the current status of the first device The scene in which you work.
  • the indication information is broadcast information received by the first device from the second device.
  • the operator information includes a public land mobile network PLMN identity.
  • the location information includes at least one of a country code, a province code, or global positioning system GPS information .
  • the service type includes a carrier aggregation CA service, a dual connection DC service, or a multiple-input multiple-output MIMO service. At least one.
  • the first obtaining unit is specifically configured to: obtain pre-made mapping information on the first device; or, Acquire mapping information from a third device, and the third device is different from the second device.
  • the first obtaining unit is specifically configured to: obtain a pre-made mapping in the user identification module SIM card of the first device. Information; or, obtaining pre-made mapping information in the memory of the first device.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information and frequency information, the indication The information is used to indicate whether to display the network icon of the second communication system; the frequency information is used to indicate whether the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the second obtaining unit is specifically configured to: receive instruction information from the second device; and obtain frequency information according to a serving frequency of a cell where the first device is located.
  • the display unit is specifically configured to: if the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, display the first network icon of the second communication system; Instruct to display the network icon of the second communication system, and if the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is not a high-frequency signal, then display the second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and scene information, and the frequency The information is used to indicate whether the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the second obtaining unit is specifically configured to obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located; and obtain scene information according to a working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the display unit is specifically configured to: when the scene information is the third working scenario or the fourth working scenario, if the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, display the first network icon of the second communication system. If the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is not a high-frequency signal, a second network icon of the second communication system is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and scene information
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system with the operator.
  • the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than a preset value and high
  • the frequency of the frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the second obtaining unit is specifically configured to obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located; and obtain scene information according to a working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the display unit is specifically configured to: when the scenario information is the third working scenario, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, if the frequency information indicates that the first device has a neighbor cell with the second communication system and the operator If the high-frequency signal is covered, the first network icon is displayed; if the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have the high-frequency signal coverage of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, the second network icon is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and connection state information And scene information, frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low frequency signal, and whether the first device is covered by the high frequency signal of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator. Set the value. The frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the second obtaining unit is specifically configured to obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located; obtain connection status information according to a current connection status; and according to the first Obtain scene information about the current working scene of the device.
  • the display unit is specifically configured to: when the scenario information is the third working scenario, the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, if the connection state information is idle or inactive, and the frequency information indicates the first device
  • the third network icon is displayed; if the connection status information is connected, and the frequency information indicates that the first device has the second communication system with the operator's phase If the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell is covered, the fourth network icon is displayed; if the connection status information is idle or inactive, and the frequency information indicates that the first device has no high-frequency signal from the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator If it is covered, the fifth network icon is displayed; if the connection status information is connected and the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have high frequency signal coverage of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, a sixth network icon is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, and Scene information
  • the indication information is used to indicate whether to display the network icon of the second communication system
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device has a second communication system related to the operator
  • the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell is covered, the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than a preset value, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the second obtaining unit is specifically configured to: receive instruction information from the second device; obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located; Work scene to get scene information.
  • the display unit is specifically configured to: when the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, the scene information is the first working scenario or the second working scenario, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, The information indicates that the first device is covered by high-frequency signals of the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the first network icon of the second communication system is displayed; if the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have the second communication system and the operator When the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell is covered, the second network icon of the second communication system is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, Connection status information and scene information.
  • the indication information is used to indicate whether the network icon of the second communication system is displayed.
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device has the second communication system.
  • the high-frequency signal coverage of the neighboring cell of the operator, the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than the preset value, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the second obtaining unit is specifically configured to: receive instruction information from the second device; obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located; and according to a current connection status Acquire connection status information; acquire scene information according to the working scene in which the first device is currently located.
  • the display unit is specifically configured to: when the scene information is the first working scene or the second working scene, the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal.
  • the seventh network icon of the second communication system is displayed; if the status information is Idle state or inactive state, and the frequency information indicates that the first device has no high-frequency signal coverage of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, the eighth network icon of the second communication system is displayed; if the state information is the connected state And the frequency information indicates that the first device is covered by high-frequency signals of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, the ninth network icon of the second communication system is displayed; if the status information is connected, and the frequency information indicates the first If a device does not have high-frequency signal coverage in the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the tenth network icon of the second communication system is displayed.
  • the seventh network icon, the eighth network icon, the ninth network icon, and the tenth network icon may be the same or different.
  • the first device further includes a third acquisition unit and a measurement unit .
  • the third obtaining unit is configured to obtain detection information before the second obtaining unit obtains frequency information, the detection information includes second parameter information, and the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal of an adjacent cell. Species.
  • the measuring unit is configured to measure a signal of an adjacent cell according to the detection information.
  • the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of a cell of the second communication system. And / or, at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal in a neighboring cell of a cell where the first device is located, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the third obtaining unit is specifically configured to: obtain pre-made detection information on the first device ; Or, the first device acquires detection information from a third device.
  • the detection information further includes second parameter information and at least one first Correspondence between three parameter information, the third parameter information includes operator information or location information.
  • the measurement information includes frequency information or cell information of a cell.
  • the time information is period information for the measurement performed by the first device.
  • the period information is the interval between the start time of the first measurement and the start time of the second measurement when the first device performs two adjacent measurements, or the end time of the first measurement and the start time of the second measurement. Interval; or the interval between the end time of the first measurement and the end time of the second measurement.
  • time information is applied to a timer, and time information is used to At least one of the following: time information is used by the first device to measure and start or restart the timer when the timer expires; or time information is used to start or restart the timer when the first device ends the measurement; or, time The information is used by the first device to reset or stop or cancel the timer when a cell reselection occurs; or, the time information is used to start the timer after the first device receives the second message sent by the second device; or, The time information is used by the first device to measure after receiving the second message sent by the second device, and to start or restart the timer when starting the measurement, or to start or restart the timer when ending the measurement.
  • the m first parameter information includes service type and scenario information .
  • the second obtaining unit is specifically configured to obtain a service type according to a service currently used by the first device; and obtain scene information according to a working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the display unit is specifically configured to: when the scenario information is the third working scenario, if the service type is carrier aggregation CA service, display the eleventh network icon; if the service type is dual-connected DC service, display the twelfth network icon; If the service type is a multiple-input multiple-output MIMO service, the thirteenth network icon is displayed; otherwise, the fourteenth network icon is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes scene information.
  • the second obtaining unit is specifically configured to obtain scene information according to a working scene in which the first device is currently located.
  • the display unit is specifically configured to: when the scene information is the second working scene, display a second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first communication system is a 4G system
  • the second communication system is a 5G system.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides an electronic device, including: a detecting unit configured to obtain detection information, the detection information including second parameter information, and the second parameter information including measurements of neighboring cells of a cell where the first device is located At least one of information or time information.
  • a measuring unit is configured to measure signals of neighboring cells according to the detection information.
  • the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of neighboring cells in the target communication system; and / or, the target communication system In at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal of an adjacent cell, the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the obtaining unit is specifically configured to: obtain pre-made detection information on the first device; or, The third device acquires detection information.
  • the detection information further includes a correspondence between the second parameter information and at least one third parameter information, and the third The parameter information includes operator information or location information.
  • the operator information includes a public land mobile network PLMN identity; the location information includes a country code or a province or city code or At least one of GPS positioning information.
  • the measurement information includes cell frequency information or cell information.
  • the time information is periodic information measured by the first device, and the periodic information is adjacent to the first device.
  • time information is applied to a timer, and time information is used for at least one of the following: time information is used for the first A device measures when the timer expires, and starts or restarts the timer; or, the time information is used to start or restart the timer when the first device ends the measurement; or, the time information is used when the first device acquires the detection After the information, the timer is started; or, the time information is used by the first device to measure after acquiring the information, and to start or restart the timer when the measurement starts, or to start or restart the timer when the measurement ends.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides a first device including a display screen, one or more processors, and one or more memories; the display screen, one or more memories are coupled with one or more processors, One or more memories are used to store computer program code.
  • the computer program code includes computer instructions. When one or more processors execute the computer instructions, the processors are used to obtain mapping information.
  • the mapping information includes multiple correspondences, and multiple correspondences.
  • the relationship is used to indicate the correspondence between n first parameter information and multiple network icons, n is a positive integer, the first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, service type, operator information, location information, connection status information, or Scene information, connection state information includes idle state, inactive state or connected state; obtain m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working state of the first device, m is a positive integer less than or equal to n .
  • the display screen is configured to display a network icon according to a correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon.
  • the scenario information includes: a first working scenario, and a cell where the first device is located is a cell of the first communication system and supports cooperation with the second communication system. Networking; or, in the second working scenario, the first device is registered with the core network of the second communication system through the air interface of the first communication system; or, in the third working scenario, the cell where the first device is located is the cell of the second communication system Or, in a fourth working scenario, the first device is connected to a base station of the first communication system, and the first device has a secondary base station of the second communication system.
  • the third working scenario includes: a serving cell when the first device is in a connected state is a cell of the second communication system; or a residential cell when the first device is in an idle or inactive state is a cell of the second communication system .
  • the working status of the first device includes: a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located, and a The frequency of signals of neighboring cells, the service currently used by the first device, the operator currently used by the first device, the current location of the first device, the current connection status of the first device, or the current status of the first device The scene in which you work.
  • the indication information is broadcast information received by the first device from the second device.
  • the operator information includes a public land mobile network PLMN identity.
  • the location information includes at least one of a country code, a province code, or global positioning system GPS information .
  • the service type includes a carrier aggregation CA service, a dual connection DC service, or a multiple-input multiple-output MIMO service. At least one.
  • the processor is specifically configured to: obtain pre-made mapping information on the first device; or, Three devices acquire mapping information, and the third device is different from the second device.
  • the processor is specifically configured to: obtain pre-made mapping information in the user identity identification module SIM card of the first device; Or, obtain pre-made mapping information in the memory of the first device.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information and frequency information, and the indication The information is used to indicate whether to display the network icon of the second communication system; the frequency information is used to indicate whether the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the processor is specifically configured to: receive instruction information from the second device; and acquire frequency information according to a serving frequency of a cell where the first device is located.
  • the display screen is specifically used to display the first network icon of the second communication system if the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal; Instruct to display the network icon of the second communication system, and if the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is not a high-frequency signal, then display the second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and scene information, and the frequency The information is used to indicate whether the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the processor is specifically configured to obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located; and acquire scene information according to a working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the display screen is specifically configured to: when the scene information is the third working scene or the fourth working scene, if the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, display the first network icon of the second communication system. If the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is not a high-frequency signal, a second network icon of the second communication system is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and scene information
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system with the operator.
  • the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than a preset value and high.
  • the frequency of the frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the processor is specifically configured to obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located; and acquire scene information according to a working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the display screen is specifically used: when the scenario information is the third working scenario, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, if the frequency information indicates that the first device has a neighboring cell with the second communication system and the operator If the high-frequency signal is covered, the first network icon is displayed; if the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have the high-frequency signal coverage of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, the second network icon is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes frequency information and connection state information And scene information, frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low frequency signal, and whether the first device is covered by the high frequency signal of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator. Set the value. The frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the processor is specifically configured to: obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located; obtain connection status information according to a current connection status; Get the scene information for your working scene.
  • the display screen is specifically used: when the scenario information is the third working scenario, the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, if the connection status information is idle or inactive, and the frequency information indicates the first device
  • the third network icon is displayed; if the connection status information is connected, and the frequency information indicates that the first device has the second communication system with the operator's phase If the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell is covered, the fourth network icon is displayed; if the connection status information is idle or inactive, and the frequency information indicates that the first device has no high-frequency signal from the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator If it is covered, the fifth network icon is displayed; if the connection status information is connected and the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have high frequency signal coverage of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, a sixth network icon is displayed.
  • the third network icon, the fourth network icon, the fifth network icon, and the sixth network icon is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, and Scene information
  • the indication information is used to indicate whether to display the network icon of the second communication system
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device has a second communication system related to the operator
  • the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell is covered, the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than a preset value, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the processor is specifically configured to: receive instruction information from the second device; obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located; Scene gets scene information.
  • the display screen is specifically used: when the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, the scene information is the first working scene or the second working scene, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low frequency signal, The information indicates that the first device is covered by high-frequency signals of the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the first network icon of the second communication system is displayed; if the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have the second communication system and the operator When the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell is covered, the second network icon of the second communication system is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes indication information, frequency information, Connection status information and scene information.
  • the indication information is used to indicate whether the network icon of the second communication system is displayed.
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device has the second communication system.
  • the high-frequency signal coverage of the neighboring cell of the operator, the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than the preset value, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the processor is specifically configured to: receive instruction information from the second device; obtain frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located; and obtain a connection according to a current connection status. Status information; obtaining scene information according to the working scene in which the first device is currently located.
  • the display screen is specifically used: when the scene information is the first working scene or the second working scene, the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal.
  • the seventh network icon of the second communication system is displayed; if the status information is Idle state or inactive state, and the frequency information indicates that the first device does not have high frequency signal coverage of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, the eighth network icon of the second communication system is displayed; if the state information is connected state And the frequency information indicates that the first device is covered by high-frequency signals of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, the ninth network icon of the second communication system is displayed; if the status information is connected, and the frequency information indicates the first If a device does not have high-frequency signal coverage in the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the tenth network icon of the second communication system is displayed.
  • the seventh network icon, the eighth network icon, the ninth network icon, and the tenth network icon may be the same or different.
  • the first device further includes a third obtaining unit, configured to: Obtaining detection information before the second obtaining unit obtains frequency information, the detection information includes second parameter information, and the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal of an adjacent cell; the first device according to the detection Information measures the signals of neighboring cells.
  • the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of a cell of the second communication system. And / or, at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal in a neighboring cell of a cell where the first device is located, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the third acquisition unit is specifically configured to acquire pre-made detection information on the first device ; Or, the first device acquires detection information from a third device.
  • the detection information further includes second parameter information and at least one first Correspondence between three parameter information, the third parameter information includes operator information or location information.
  • the measurement information includes frequency information or cell information of a cell.
  • the time information is period information for the first device to measure
  • the period information is the interval between the start time of the first measurement and the start time of the second measurement when the first device performs two adjacent measurements, or the end time of the first measurement and the start time of the second measurement. Interval; or the interval between the end time of the first measurement and the end time of the second measurement.
  • time information is applied to a timer, and time information is used to At least one of the following: time information is used by the first device to measure and start or restart the timer when the timer expires; or time information is used to start or restart the timer when the first device ends the measurement; or, time The information is used by the first device to reset or stop or cancel the timer when a cell reselection occurs; or, the time information is used to start the timer after the first device receives the second message sent by the second device; or, The time information is used by the first device to measure after receiving the second message sent by the second device, and to start or restart the timer when starting the measurement, or to start or restart the timer when ending the measurement.
  • the m first parameter information includes service type and scenario information .
  • the processor is specifically configured to: obtain a service type according to a service currently used by the first device; and obtain scene information according to a working scenario where the first device is currently located.
  • the display screen is specifically used: when the scenario information is the third working scenario, if the service type is carrier aggregation CA service, the eleventh network icon is displayed; if the service type is dual-connected DC service, the twelfth network icon is displayed; If the service type is a multiple-input multiple-output MIMO service, the thirteenth network icon is displayed; otherwise, the fourteenth network icon is displayed.
  • the m first parameter information includes scene information.
  • the processor is specifically configured to obtain scene information according to a working scene in which the first device is currently located.
  • the display screen is specifically configured to: when the scene information is the second working scene, display a second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first communication system is a 4G system
  • the second communication system is a 5G system.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides an electronic device including one or more processors and one or more memories; a display screen, one or more memories are coupled with one or more processors, and one or more
  • the memory is configured to store computer program code.
  • the computer program code includes computer instructions.
  • the processor executes the computer instructions, the processor is configured to obtain detection information.
  • the detection information includes second parameter information.
  • the second parameter information includes the first parameter. At least one of measurement information or time information of a neighboring cell of a cell where the device is located. Then, the signals of the neighboring cells are measured according to the detection information.
  • the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of neighboring cells in the target communication system; and / or, the target communication system In at least one of measurement information or time information of a high-frequency signal of an adjacent cell, the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the processor is specifically configured to: obtain pre-made detection information on the first device; or, The third device acquires detection information.
  • the detection information further includes a correspondence between the second parameter information and at least one third parameter information, and the third The parameter information includes operator information or location information.
  • the operator information includes a public land mobile network PLMN identity; the location information includes a country code or a province or city code or At least one of GPS positioning information.
  • the measurement information includes frequency information or cell information of a cell.
  • the time information is period information measured by the first device, and the period information is adjacent to the first device.
  • time information is applied to a timer, and time information is used for at least one of the following: time information is used for the first A device measures when the timer expires, and starts or restarts the timer; or, the time information is used to start or restart the timer when the first device ends the measurement; or, the time information is used when the first device acquires the detection After the information, the timer is started; or, the time information is used by the first device to measure after acquiring the information, and to start or restart the timer when the measurement starts, or to start or restart the timer when the measurement ends.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides an electronic device including one or more processors and one or more memories.
  • the one or more memories are coupled to one or more processors.
  • the one or more memories are used to store computer program code.
  • the computer program code includes computer instructions.
  • the electronic device executes the instructions.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides a computer storage medium including computer instructions, and when the computer instructions are run on the electronic device, the electronic device executes the display control method in any one of the possible implementations of the foregoing aspect or Measurement methods.
  • the technical solution of the present application provides a computer program product.
  • the computer program product runs on an electronic device, the electronic device executes a display control method or a measurement method in any one of the possible designs of the foregoing aspects.
  • FIG. 1 is a schematic diagram of a system architecture according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 2 is a schematic structural diagram of a communication device according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 3 is a flowchart of a method according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 4 is a schematic diagram of displaying a network icon according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 9 is a schematic diagram of periodic information according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 10 is a schematic structural diagram of a first device according to an embodiment of the present application.
  • System information system information block (system information block, SIB), scheduling information of the SIB, carried through the master information block (master information block, MIB) or scheduling block (scheduling block, SB).
  • the information contained in the SIB may include: non-access stratum (NAS) system information, terminal timers / counters, parameters for cell selection and reselection, parameters for cell common physical channel configuration, and measurement Control information, the public land mobile network PLMN identification of neighboring cells in idle and connected states, and the frequency and priority of cells between different systems.
  • NAS non-access stratum
  • terminal timers / counters parameters for cell selection and reselection
  • parameters for cell common physical channel configuration parameters for cell common physical channel configuration
  • measurement Control information the public land mobile network PLMN identification of neighboring cells in idle and connected states, and the frequency and priority of cells between different systems.
  • Country code also known as country code, is a set of geographic codes used to represent countries and foreign territories. It is a short string of letters or numbers, which is convenient for data processing and communication. There are many national code standards, such as ISO 3166-1 of the International Organization for Standardization. The country code can also refer to the IDD country number, which is the international telephone area code (E.164) of the International Telecommunication Union.
  • the display control method and device provided in the embodiments of the present application can be applied to the system architecture shown in FIG. 1.
  • the first device 101 may be connected to the second device 102 in the first communication system 110 and access the core network through the second device.
  • Cells and devices of the second communication system 120 may also be deployed in the immediate area of the first device 101.
  • the first communication system 110 and the second communication system 120 may also be jointly networked to provide a dual-connected DC service for the first device 101.
  • the first communication system 110 is different from the second communication system 120.
  • the first communication system 110 may be a 4G system
  • the second communication system 120 may be a 5G system.
  • the first communication system 110 may be a 5G system.
  • the second communication system 120 may be a future public land mobile network PLMN system that has evolved after 5G.
  • the first communication system 110 may be a 5G system, and the second communication system 120 may be a 4G system; or the first communication system 110 may be a future PLMN system that evolves after 5G, and the second communication system 120 may be a 5G system.
  • the embodiment of the present application does not specifically limit which communication system the first communication system 110 and the second communication system 120 are.
  • the first device 101 may be a terminal, and may specifically be a user equipment (UE), an access terminal, a terminal unit, a terminal station, a mobile station, a mobile station, a remote station, a remote terminal, a mobile device, and a wireless communication device. , Terminal agent or terminal device, etc.
  • Access terminals can be cellular phones, cordless phones, session initiation protocol (SIP) phones, wireless local loop (WLL) stations, personal digital processing (PDA), computers, laptops Computers, handheld computing devices, and / or other devices used to communicate on wireless systems.
  • SIP session initiation protocol
  • WLL wireless local loop
  • PDA personal digital processing
  • Wireless communication-capable handheld devices computing devices, or other processing devices connected to a wireless modem, satellite wireless devices, wireless modem cards, TV set-top boxes (STB), customer premise equipment (CPE), automotive Devices, wearable devices, terminals in 5G networks, or terminals in future evolved PLMN networks.
  • STB TV set-top boxes
  • CPE customer premise equipment
  • automotive Devices wearable devices, terminals in 5G networks, or terminals in future evolved PLMN networks.
  • the second device 102 may be an access network device in a communication system.
  • the access network device may be a base station, a relay station, or an access point.
  • the base station can be a global mobile communication system (Global System for Mobile Communication, GSM) or a code division multiple access (Code Division Multiple Access, CDMA) network. It can also be a base transceiver station (BTS), or a broadband code division.
  • NB NodeB in wideband code division multiple access (WCDMA) may also be eNB or eNodeB (evolutional NodeB) in LTE.
  • the access network device may also be a wireless controller in a cloud radio access network (CRAN) scenario.
  • the access network device may also be a next-generation base station gNB in a 5G network or an access network device in a future evolved PLMN system.
  • FIG. 2 shows a schematic structural diagram of a communication device 200.
  • the communication device 200 may be a first device and a second device involved in the embodiments of the present application, and may specifically be a chip, a base station, a terminal, or other network devices. .
  • the communication device 200 includes one or more processors 201.
  • the processor 201 may be a general-purpose processor or a special-purpose processor. For example, it may be a baseband processor or a central processing unit.
  • the baseband processor may be used to process communication protocols and communication data
  • the central processor may be used to control the communication device 200 (such as a base station, a terminal, or a chip, etc.), execute a software program, and process the data of the software program.
  • the network device may include one or more modules, and the one or more modules may be implemented by one or more processors, or one or more processors and memories.
  • the communication device 200 includes one or more processors 201, and the one or more processors 201 can implement the functions of intra-frequency, inter-frequency, inter-system measurement and display of communication system information.
  • the processor 201 may also implement other functions.
  • the processor 201 may include an instruction 203 (sometimes also referred to as a code or a program), and the instruction may be executed on the processor, so that the communication device 200 performs the method described in the embodiment of the present application.
  • the communication device 200 may also include a circuit, and the circuit may implement functions such as measurement of different systems and display of communication system information in the embodiments of the present application.
  • the communication device 200 may include one or more memories 202 on which instructions 204 are stored, and the instructions may be executed on a processor, so that the communication device 200 executes the method described in the foregoing method embodiment. Methods.
  • data can also be stored in the memory.
  • Instructions and / or data can also be stored in the optional processor.
  • the processor and memory can be set separately or integrated.
  • the communication device 200 may further include a transceiver 205 and an antenna 206.
  • the processor 201 may be referred to as a processing unit, and controls the communication device 200 (terminal or base station).
  • the transceiver 205 may be referred to as a transceiver unit, a transceiver, a transceiver circuit, and the like, and is configured to implement a transceiver function of the communication device through the antenna 206.
  • the communication device 200 may further include a modem for inter-frequency measurement and the like.
  • the functions of these devices may be implemented by one or more processors 201.
  • the communication device 200 may further include a display 207 for displaying information of the communication system, displaying a graphical user interface (GUI), displaying information input by the user or information provided to the user, and various types of mobile phones. Menu and can also accept user input.
  • GUI graphical user interface
  • An embodiment of the present application provides a display control method. Referring to FIG. 3, the method may include:
  • the first device obtains mapping information.
  • the mapping information includes multiple correspondences.
  • the multiple correspondences are used to indicate correspondences between n first parameter information and multiple network icons.
  • N is a positive integer.
  • the first parameter information includes an indication.
  • Connection status information includes idle, inactive, or connected status.
  • the scenario information may include: a first working scenario, a cell where the first device is located is a cell of the first communication system, and supports joint networking with the second communication system (also referred to as supporting non-standalone (NSA) networking) ); Or, in the second working scenario, the first device is registered with the core network of the second communication system through the air interface of the first communication system; or, in the third working scenario, the cell where the first device is located is the cell of the second communication system; Alternatively, in the fourth working scenario, the first device is connected to a base station of the first communication system, and the first device has a secondary base station of the second communication system.
  • the third working scenario may include: a serving cell when the first device is in a connected state is a cell of a second communication system; or a residential cell when the first device is in an idle state or an inactive state is a cell of the second communication system Plot.
  • the second communication system may be a 5G system
  • the first communication system may be a 4G system.
  • the above first working scenario may include: a cell where the first device is located is a 4G LTE cell and supports joint networking with a 5G new radio (NR) cell.
  • the above second working scenario may include: the first device works under an eLTE base station, and is registered with a core network of a 5G system through an air interface of a 4G system.
  • the above third working scenario may include: the first device is connected to an NR cell, or the first device resides in an NR cell.
  • the above fourth working scenario may include: the first device is connected to a 4G LTE base station, and the first device has a secondary base station of a 5G system.
  • the multiple correspondences in the mapping information may specifically be a correspondence between a first parameter information and a plurality of network icons, or a correspondence between a combination of multiple first parameter information and a plurality of network icons.
  • each type of the first parameter information may specifically include one parameter and may include multiple parameters.
  • each row represents a correspondence relationship.
  • the network icon is related to the first parameter information marked with a “ ⁇ ” mark.
  • the mapping information may include the correspondence between any one of the indication information, frequency information, service type, operator information, or location information and the network icon.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between the indication information and the network icon.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between frequency information and a network icon.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between a service type and a network icon.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between operator information and network icons.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between location information and a network icon.
  • the mapping information includes a corresponding relationship between the connection status information and the network icon.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between scene information and a network icon.
  • the mapping information may further include a corresponding relationship between any combination of indication information, frequency information, service type, operator information, or location information and multiple network icons.
  • the mapping information includes the correspondence between the indication information and the frequency information and the network icon.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between frequency information and connection status information and a network icon.
  • the mapping information includes frequency information, connection state information, and corresponding relationships between scene information and network icons.
  • the mapping information includes the corresponding relationship between the indication information, the operator information, and the location information and the network icon.
  • the mapping information includes frequency information, service types, and corresponding relationships between operator information and network icons.
  • mapping information may also include other correspondences other than the examples listed in Table 1, which are not listed in the embodiments of this application.
  • the first device acquires m first parameter information from the second device and / or according to the working state of the first device, where m is a positive integer less than or equal to n.
  • the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located the frequency of signals of neighboring cells of the cell where the first device is located, the service currently used by the first device, the operator currently used by the first device, and the location where the first device is currently located. Location, the connection status where the first device is currently located, or the working scenario where the first device is currently located, and so on.
  • the first device may obtain m first parameter information from the second device; or the first device may obtain m first parameter information from the first device according to the working state of the first device; or, the first device A part of the parameter information of the m first parameter information may be obtained from the second device, and another part of the parameter information of the m first parameter information may be obtained from the first device itself according to the working state of the first device.
  • the first device displays a network icon according to the correspondence between the m first parameter information and the network icon.
  • the first device After the first device acquires the m first parameter information in the above step 302, it may search for the network icon corresponding to the m first parameter information obtained in step 302 in the above mapping relationship, and display the found network icon. If the m first parameter information acquired by the first device is different, the network icon found by the first device may also be different, and then the network icon displayed by the first device may also be different.
  • the display of the network icon by the first device refers to the display of the network icon by the first device when the status bar is always on display (AOD).
  • the network icon displayed by the first device may be a “5G” icon 402 or a “5G +” icon 403 displayed in the status bar 401.
  • the first device may dynamically display different networks according to different first parameter information obtained from the second device or according to the working status of the first device.
  • the icon instead of only keeping the icon of the network registered by the first device as in the prior art, can flexibly control the display of the network icon and more conveniently meet the operation and maintenance requirements of the operator.
  • the indication information in the first parameter information may be information received by the first device from the second device.
  • the indication information may be broadcast information received by the first device from the second device.
  • the broadcast information may specifically be system information
  • the second device may be a base station
  • the base station may send the indication information to the first device through the system information.
  • the first device may flexibly display different network icons according to different indication information sent by the base station.
  • the first parameter information may further include operator information.
  • the operator information in the first parameter information is used to indicate the operator used by the first device.
  • the operator information may include the public land mobile network PLMN identification, the name of the operator (such as Mobile, Unicom, Telecom, etc.) or the operator. Organization code, etc.
  • the first parameter information may further include location information.
  • the location information in the first parameter information is used to indicate a location where the first device is located.
  • the location information may include a country code, a province code, a global positioning system GPS information, or a geographic location where the first device is located At least one of the names.
  • the province and city codes refer to geographic codes of each region (for example, each province or city), and may be, for example, a telephone area code.
  • the service type in the first parameter information is used to indicate a type of a service currently used by the first device, and may include, for example, one or more of a carrier aggregation CA service, a dual connection DC service, or a multiple-input multiple-output MIMO service.
  • the first device can flexibly display different network icons according to different services currently used.
  • the network icon displayed by the first device may be different if the first device is currently in a different connection state or the first device is in a different working scenario. Therefore, the first parameter information can flexibly display different network icons according to different connection states and state information and scene information corresponding to the working scene.
  • the mapping information may specifically be information obtained by the first device from another device.
  • the first device may obtain the mapping information from a third device, and the third device may be the same base station as the second device.
  • the first device may obtain the mapping information from a third device different from the second device, the second device may be a base station, and the third device may be a network device such as a cloud server.
  • the first device acquiring the mapping information from other devices such as a cloud server can save the air interface signaling overhead of the base station.
  • the mapping information may specifically be information pre-made on the first device, and the first device may obtain the pre-made information from the device.
  • the mapping information may be prefabricated in a SIM card of the user identification module.
  • the SIM card may be a physical card or a virtual card.
  • the first device may obtain the prefabricated mapping information from the SIM card.
  • the mapping information may be pre-made in a memory of the first device, and the first device may obtain the pre-made mapping information from the memory.
  • mapping information can also be pre-made in an external storage device (such as an SD card or a mobile hard disk, etc.).
  • an external storage device such as an SD card or a mobile hard disk, etc.
  • the first device can be removed from the external storage device. Get pre-made mapping information.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between the indication information and the network icon, that is, the mapping information is used to indicate the meaning of the indication information.
  • the m first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 includes indication information.
  • the indication information in the mapping information includes 1-bit information, which is used to correspond to two different network icons.
  • the indication information "0" corresponds to the "5G” icon
  • the indication information "1" corresponds to the "5G +” icon.
  • the first device may determine that the network icon corresponding to the indication information "1" is “1” according to the mapping information shown in Table 2. 5G + “icon, so the first device can display the” 5G + "icon in the status bar of the first device.
  • the indication information in the mapping information includes 2-bit information, which is used to correspond to 3 different network icons.
  • the indication information "00" corresponds to the "4G” icon
  • the indication information "01” corresponds to the "5G” icon
  • the indication information "10” corresponds to the "5G +” icon.
  • the first device may determine that the network icon corresponding to the instruction information "01” is “01” according to the mapping information shown in Table 3. 5G “icon, so the first device can display the” 5G “icon. If the 2-bit instruction information received by the first device from the base station in step 302 is "10", the first device may determine that the network icon corresponding to the instruction information "10” is the "5G +” icon according to the mapping information shown in Table 3. Thus, the first device can display a "5G +" icon.
  • the mapping information includes the corresponding relationship between the indication information and the operator information and the network icon, and the meaning of the indication information corresponding to different operators is different.
  • the m first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 includes indication information and operator information.
  • the operator information is a PLMN identity
  • the indication information is 2-bit information.
  • the 2-bit instruction information received by the first device from the base station is "01”
  • the operator currently used by the first device is operator 1
  • the first device is based on the currently used operator 1.
  • the obtained operator information is PLMN1, and according to the mapping information shown in Table 4, the first device can determine that the network icon corresponding to the operator 1 and the indication information "01" is the "5G” icon, so the first device can display "5G" "icon.
  • the first device can determine that the network icon corresponding to the operator 2 and the indication information "11" is the "5G +" icon, so the first device can display the "5G +" icon.
  • the first device can flexibly display different network icons according to different instruction information sent by the second device.
  • the mapping information includes the correspondence between the indication information and the location information and the network icon, and the meaning of the indication information corresponding to different regions is different.
  • the m first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 includes indication information and location information.
  • the location information is the abbreviation of the country name, US means the United States, CHINA means China, and the indication information is 2-bit information.
  • the location information and the indication information and the network icon see Table 5 below.
  • the first device may determine that the network icon corresponding to the US and the indication information "01" is an "LTE-A” icon, so the first device may display an "LTE-A” icon.
  • the first device is based on The mapping information shown in Table 5 can determine that the network icon corresponding to CHINA and the indication information "11" is the "5G +" icon, so the first device can display the "5G +" icon.
  • the mapping information includes the corresponding relationship between the indication information, the operator information and the location information, and the network icons.
  • the indication information corresponding to different operators and different regions has different meanings.
  • the m pieces of first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 include indication information, operator information, and location information. For example, the correspondence between the indication information, the operator information, and the location information and the network icons can be seen in Table 6 below.
  • the 2-bit instruction information received by the first device from the base station is "01"; the current location of the first device is the United States, and the location information obtained by the first device according to the current location is US ;
  • the operator currently used by the first device is operator 2, and the first device according to the operator information currently used is PLMN2; then the first device can determine the US,
  • the network icon corresponding to the PLMN2 and the indication information "01" is the "5G" icon, so the first device can display the "5G” icon.
  • the mapping information includes the correspondence between the indication information and the frequency information and the network icon.
  • the m first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 includes indication information and frequency information.
  • the indication information is used to indicate whether a network icon of the second communication system is displayed, and the frequency information is used to indicate whether a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal.
  • the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value (for example, 6 GHz).
  • the above step 302 may specifically include:
  • a first device receives instruction information from a second device.
  • the first device acquires frequency information according to a serving frequency of a cell where the first device is located.
  • the above step 303 may specifically include:
  • the first device displays the first network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first device displays the second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the second communication system is a 5G system (or called an NR system);
  • the indication information is 1-bit information, "0" indicates that the network icon of the 5G system is not displayed, and "1" indicates that the network icon of the 5G system is displayed;
  • the frequency information in the message includes "the service frequency is a low frequency signal” and "the service frequency is a high frequency signal”; or, the frequency information includes " ⁇ 6GHz (Hertz)" and " ⁇ 6GHz".
  • Table 7 For the correspondence between the frequency information and the indication information and the network icons, see Table 7 below.
  • the 2-bit instruction information received by the first device from the base station is "1"; the service frequency of the cell in which the first device is currently located is 6.5 GHz, and the first device obtains the service frequency of the cell in which the first device is currently located.
  • the frequency information in the obtained first parameter information is "the service frequency is a high-frequency signal”, then the first device determines according to Table 7 that the network icon corresponding to the indication information "1" and the frequency information "the service frequency is a high-frequency signal" is " 5G + "icon, so the first device displays the” 5G + "icon.
  • the mapping information includes the correspondence between frequency information and network icons.
  • the m first parameter information obtained by the first device in step 302 includes frequency information and scene information.
  • the frequency information is used to indicate whether the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a high-frequency signal, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value (for example, 6 GHz).
  • step 302 may specifically include:
  • the first device acquires frequency information according to a serving frequency of a cell where the first device is located.
  • the first device acquires scene information according to a working scenario in which the first device is currently located.
  • the above step 303 may specifically include:
  • the first device displays a first network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first device displays a second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the third working scenario may include: the first device is connected to the NR cell, or the first device resides in the NR cell; the fourth working scenario may be The first device is connected to a 4G LTE base station, and the first device has a secondary base station of a 5G system.
  • the second communication system is a 5G system
  • the first communication system is a 4G system
  • the frequency information in the first parameter information includes "service frequency is a low frequency signal” and “service frequency is a high frequency signal”
  • the frequency information includes " ⁇ 6GHz “and” ⁇ 6GHz ".
  • the scene information in the m first parameter information obtained by the first device in step 302 is the fourth job. Scenario; if the serving frequency of the cell where the first device is currently located is 4.7 GHz, the frequency information in the m first parameter information obtained by the first device according to the serving frequency of the current cell in step 302 is "the serving frequency is a low-frequency signal ", The first device may determine according to Table 8 that the scene information is” the fourth working scene “and the frequency information is” the service frequency is a low frequency signal ".
  • the corresponding network icon is the" 5G “icon, and therefore the" 5G "icon may be displayed.
  • the first device when the first device is registered in the core network of the second communication system through the air interface of the first communication system, and the first device has a secondary base station of the second communication system, for example, the first device works in an eLTE base station
  • the air interface of the 4G system when the air interface of the 4G system is registered in the core network of the 5G system, and there is a secondary base station of the 5G system, the first device is also currently in the fourth scenario, and the network icon can be displayed using the solution in (6).
  • the mapping information includes the correspondence between frequency information and scene information and network icons.
  • the m first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 includes frequency information and scene information.
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator.
  • the neighboring cell of the same operator refers to the neighboring cell of the same operator corresponding to the cell where the first device is located.
  • the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than a preset value (for example, 6 GHz), and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • step 302 may specifically include:
  • the first device acquires frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell in which the first device is located and a frequency of a signal in a neighboring cell of the cell in which the first device is located.
  • the first device acquires scene information according to a working scenario in which the first device is currently located.
  • the above step 303 may specifically include:
  • the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, A device displays a first network icon.
  • the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and the first device does not have the high-frequency signal coverage of the second communication system and the neighboring cell of the operator, the first A device displays a second network icon.
  • the third working scenario may include: the first device is connected to the NR cell, or the first device resides in the NR cell.
  • the frequency information in the first parameter information may include "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and there is no high-frequency signal coverage in a neighboring cell of the second communication system with the operator” and "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and there is a second communication system High-frequency signal coverage in neighbouring cells of the same operator. "
  • the second communication system is a 5G system
  • the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal
  • the NR cell is not The cell where the first device is located is an adjacent cell of the cell where the first device is located. Therefore, if the first device has high-frequency signal coverage from the NR cell of the same operator, it can indicate that the first device has an adjacent cell to the operator High-frequency signal coverage of the NR cell.
  • the frequency information may specifically include "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and the high-frequency signal coverage of the NR cell of a different operator" and "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the NR cell of the same operator".
  • the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the NR cell of the same operator.
  • the scene information obtained by the first device in step 302 is the third working scenario.
  • the service frequency of the NR cell where the first device is located is less than a preset value (for example, 6 GHz)
  • the service frequency is a low frequency signal
  • the NR cell where the first device is located is a low frequency cell.
  • the frequency of the signal of the adjacent NR cell of the cell where the first device is located includes a high-frequency signal greater than a preset value (for example, 6 GHz)
  • the NR cell is also a 5G system and corresponds to the same operator as the cell where the first device is located.
  • the first device may determine that the frequency information obtained in step 302 is "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the NR cell of the same operator". According to the mapping relationship shown in Table 9, the first device may determine that the icons corresponding to the m first parameter information obtained in step 302 are "5G +" icons, so that the "5G +" icon may be displayed in the status bar.
  • the cell where the first device is located is an NR low-frequency cell of a 5G system, and the first device is covered by the NR high-frequency cell of the same operator, it can be explained that the cell where the first device is located has an NR high-frequency cell added as a secondary cell.
  • the first device can display other icons different from the "5G" icon, for example, it can display the "5G +" icon.
  • the second communication system is a 5G system
  • the frequency information in the first parameter information includes a service frequency of a low frequency signal and a frequency value of at least one high frequency signal of an adjacent NR cell corresponding to the same operator as the first device.
  • a service frequency of a low frequency signal and a frequency value of at least one high frequency signal of an adjacent NR cell corresponding to the same operator as the first device.
  • 6.5GHz, 7.2GHz and 8.4GHz Exemplarily, the correspondence between the scene information and the frequency information and the network icon can be seen in Table 10 below.
  • the scene information obtained by the first device in step 302 is the third working scenario; if the first device is based on the NR cell where it is located And the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal; and the frequency of the signal of the neighboring NR cell of the cell where the first device is located includes 6.5 GHz, the first device performs step 302
  • the obtained frequency information is "the service frequency is a low frequency signal, and the service frequency of the neighboring NR cell includes 6.5GHz, 7.2GHz or 8.4GHz".
  • the first device determines that the icons corresponding to the m first parameter information in step 302 are "5G +" icons, so the first device can display the "5G +" icons.
  • 6.5GHz is a frequency value of a high-frequency signal of an adjacent NR cell corresponding to the same operator as the first device. Therefore, when the frequency of the signal of the adjacent NR cell of the cell where the first device is located includes 6.5GHz, it can be shown that The first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of an adjacent NR cell of the same operator.
  • the scene information obtained by the first device is the third working scenario; if the neighboring NR cell of the cell where the first device is located is The frequency of the signal does not include 6.5GHz, 7.2GHz, and 8.4GHz.
  • the first device does not have high-frequency signal coverage from neighboring NR cells of the same operator.
  • the first device can display the "5G" icon according to the mapping relationship shown in Table 10. .
  • the second communication system is a 5G system
  • the frequency information in the first parameter information includes a range of a low-frequency service signal and a high-frequency signal of an adjacent NR cell with an operator.
  • the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low frequency signal
  • the high frequency signal is a high frequency signal of an adjacent cell.
  • the frequency information may specifically include "the service frequency is a low frequency signal, the service frequency of the NR cell of the same operator is ⁇ 6GHz", and "the service frequency is the low frequency signal, the service frequency of the NR cell of the same operator is the ⁇ 6GHz".
  • Table 11 Exemplarily, the correspondence between the scene information and frequency information and the network icon can be seen in Table 11 below.
  • the mapping information includes the correspondence between frequency information, connection status information, and scene information and network icons.
  • the m pieces of first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 include frequency information, connection state information, and scene information.
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, and the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than a preset value.
  • the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to a preset value.
  • the above step 302 may specifically include:
  • the first device acquires frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located.
  • the first device acquires connection state information according to a current connection state.
  • the first device acquires scene information according to a working scenario in which the first device is currently located.
  • the above step 303 may specifically include:
  • scenario information is the third working scenario
  • the connection status information is idle or inactive
  • the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal
  • the first device has a second communication system with the operator.
  • the high-frequency signals of the neighboring cells are covered, and the first device displays a third network icon.
  • the connection state information is the connected state
  • the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and the first device has a neighbor cell of the second communication system and the operator.
  • the high-frequency signal covers, and the first device displays a fourth network icon.
  • scenario information is the third working scenario
  • the connection status information is idle or inactive
  • the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and the first device has no second communication system with the operator.
  • the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell is covered, and the first device displays a fifth network icon.
  • the connection state information is the connected state
  • the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and the first device has no The high-frequency signal covers, and the first device displays a sixth network icon.
  • the third network icon, the fourth network icon, the fifth network icon, and the sixth network icon may be the same or different.
  • the third working scenario may include: the first device is connected to the NR cell, or the first device resides in the NR cell.
  • the frequency information in the first parameter information may include "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and there is no high-frequency signal coverage in an adjacent cell of the second communication system operator” and "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and there is a second communication system High-frequency signal coverage in neighbouring cells of the same operator. "
  • the second communication system is a 5G system and the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal
  • the NR cell is not the first
  • the cell where a device is located is a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located. Therefore, if the first device has high-frequency signal coverage of the NR cell of the same operator, it can be shown that the first device has an adjacent NR of the same operator. High-frequency signal coverage of the cell.
  • the frequency information may specifically include "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and the high-frequency signal coverage of the NR cell without the same operator” and "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the NR cell of the same operator".
  • the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the NR cell of the same operator.
  • the first device When the second communication system is a 5G system, the first device is in the "third working scenario, and the idle state (or inactive state)" indicates that the first device resides in the NR cell; the first device is in the "third working scenario.” , Connected state) "means that the first device is connected to the NR cell.
  • the scenario information obtained by the first device in step 320 is the third working scenario and the obtained connection status.
  • the message is idle or inactive. If the serving frequency of the NR cell where the first device is currently located is less than a preset value (for example, 6 GHz), the serving frequency is a low frequency signal, and the NR cell where the first device is located is a low frequency cell.
  • a preset value for example, 6 GHz
  • the frequency information obtained by the first device in step 302 may be "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the NR cell of the same operator".
  • the first device may determine that the icon corresponding to the m first parameter information is a "5G +" icon according to the mapping relationship corresponding to the configuration 1, so the first device may display a "5G +" icon.
  • the mapping information includes frequency information, connection state information, and corresponding relationships between scene information and network icons.
  • the m pieces of first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 include indication information, frequency information, and scene information.
  • the indication information is used to indicate whether to display a network icon of the second communication system;
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device has a second communication system adjacent to the operator
  • the high-frequency signal coverage of the community, the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than the preset value, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • step 302 may specifically include:
  • the first device receives instruction information from a second device.
  • the first device obtains frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell in which the first device is located and a frequency of a signal in a neighboring cell of the cell in which the first device is located.
  • the first device acquires scene information according to a working scenario in which the first device is currently located.
  • the above step 303 may specifically include:
  • the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed
  • the scenario information is the first working scenario or the second working scenario
  • the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal
  • the first device has the second communication.
  • the system covers the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell of the operator, and the first device displays the first network icon of the second communication system.
  • the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed
  • the scenario information is the first working scenario or the second working scenario
  • the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and the first device has no second communication.
  • the system covers the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell of the operator, and the first device displays a second network icon of the second communication system.
  • the first working scenario may include: the cell where the first device is located is a 4G LTE cell and supports joint networking with the 5G NR cell;
  • the second working scenario may include: the first device works under an eLTE base station, and is registered with the core network of the 5G system through the air interface of the 4G system.
  • the second communication system is a 5G system
  • the indication information in the first parameter information may be 1-bit information, where the indication information "1" indicates that the network icon of the 5G system is displayed; the indication information "0" indicates that the network icon of the 5G system is not displayed .
  • the frequency information in the first parameter information includes "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and the high-frequency signal coverage of the NR cell of a different operator” and “the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the NR cell of the same operator” .
  • the correspondence between the scene information and the frequency information and the network icon can be seen in Table 13 below.
  • the second communication system is a 5G system
  • the first communication system is a 4G system
  • the cell where the first device is located is a 4G LTE cell and supports joint networking with the 5G NR cell
  • the first device is in step
  • the scene information obtained in 302 is a first working scene. If the service frequency of the first device according to the LTE cell is less than a preset value (for example, 6 GHz), the service frequency is a low frequency signal, and the LTE cell where the first device is located is a low frequency cell.
  • a preset value for example, 6 GHz
  • the first device determines, according to the mapping relationship shown in Table 13, that the icons corresponding to the m first parameter information in step 302 are "5G +" icons, and thus the "5G +" icons can be displayed.
  • the cell where the first device is located is a 4G LTE cell and supports joint networking with the 5G NR cell, and the first device is covered by the NR high-frequency cell of the same operator, it can be explained that the first device is located
  • the cell has the possibility of adding an NR high-frequency cell as a secondary cell, so the first device can display other icons different from the "5G" icon, such as the "5G +" icon.
  • the mapping information includes frequency information, connection state information, and corresponding relationships between scene information and network icons.
  • the m first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 includes indication information, frequency information, connection state information, and scene information.
  • the indication information is used to indicate whether to display a network icon of the second communication system;
  • the frequency information is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device has a second communication system adjacent to the operator
  • the high-frequency signal coverage of the community, the frequency of the low-frequency signal is less than the preset value, and the frequency of the high-frequency signal is greater than or equal to the preset value.
  • the above step 302 may specifically include:
  • the first device receives instruction information from the second device.
  • the first device obtains frequency information according to a service frequency of a cell where the first device is located and a frequency of a signal of a neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located.
  • the first device obtains connection state information according to a current connection state.
  • the first device acquires scene information according to a working scenario in which the first device is currently located.
  • the above step 303 may specifically include:
  • the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, the status information is idle or inactive, and the frequency information indicates the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located.
  • the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of an adjacent cell of the second communication system and the operator, and the first device displays a seventh network icon of the second communication system.
  • the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, the status information is idle or inactive, and the frequency information indicates the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located.
  • the first device does not have high-frequency signals covered by the neighboring cell of the second communication system with the operator, and the first device displays an eighth network icon of the second communication system.
  • the instruction information indicates that a network icon of the second communication system is displayed, the status information is connected status, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, If the first device is covered by a high-frequency signal of an adjacent cell of the second communication system and the operator, the first device displays a ninth network icon of the second communication system.
  • the instruction information indicates that the network icon of the second communication system is displayed, the status information is connected status, and the frequency information indicates that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, If the first device does not have high-frequency signal coverage in the neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator, the first device displays the tenth network icon of the second communication system.
  • the seventh network icon, the eighth network icon, the ninth network icon, and the tenth network icon may be the same or different.
  • the first working scenario may include: the cell where the first device is located is a 4G LTE cell and supports joint networking with the 5G NR cell; the second The working scenario may include: a first device works under an eLTE base station, and is registered with a core network of a 5G system through an air interface of a 4G system.
  • the frequency information in the first parameter information includes “the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and there is no high-frequency signal coverage of the second communication system with the neighboring cell of the operator” and “the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and the second communication system is the same High-frequency signal coverage of the operator's neighboring cells. "
  • the frequency information may specifically include “the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and the high-frequency signal coverage of an NR cell of a different operator” and "service The frequency is a low-frequency signal and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the NR cell of the operator.
  • the indication information in the first parameter information may be 1-bit information, where the indication information "1" indicates that the network icon of the 5G system is displayed; the indication information "0" indicates that the network icon of the 5G system is not displayed.
  • the scene information, connection status information, and frequency information and the network icons see Table 14 below.
  • the first device when the second communication system is a 5G system and the first communication system is a 4G system, the first device is in the "first working scenario, the idle state (or inactive state)" may include the first device residing in the support The 4G system LTE cell of the NSA; the first device in the "first working scenario, connected state” may include that the first device is connected to the 4G system LTE cell that supports the NSA.
  • the first device when the second communication system is a 5G system and the first communication system is a 4G system, the first device is in a "second working scenario, and the idle state (or inactive state)" may include that the first device resides in eLTE Cell and registered in the 5G core network; the first device in the "second working scenario, connected state” may include the first device connected to the eLTE cell and registered in the 5G core network.
  • the indication information received by the first device from the base station is "1" in step 302
  • the scenario information obtained by the first device in step 302 is the first working scenario, and the obtained connection state information is idle or inactive.
  • the serving frequency of the cell where the first device is located is less than a preset value (for example, 6 GHz), the serving frequency is a low frequency signal, and the cell where the first device is located is a low frequency cell.
  • the first device If the frequency of the signal of the adjacent NR cell of the cell where the first device is located includes a high-frequency signal greater than a preset value (for example, 6 GHz), and the adjacent cell corresponds to the same operator as the cell where the first device is located, the first device
  • the frequency information obtained in step 302 may be "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and is covered by a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the same system and operator".
  • the first device can use the mapping relationship corresponding to the configuration 1 to determine the icon corresponding to the m first parameter information obtained in the step 302 as a "5G +" icon, so the first device "5G +" icon can be displayed.
  • the first device when the first device resides in a 4G system LTE cell that supports NSA under the first working scenario, and the first device is covered by the NR high-frequency cell of the same operator, it can be explained that the cell where the first device is located has added The possibility of the NR high-frequency cell as a secondary cell, so the first device can display other icons different from the "5G" icon, such as the "5G +" icon.
  • the mapping information includes the correspondence between the service type and scene information and the network icon.
  • the m first parameter information obtained by the first device in step 302 includes the service type and scene information.
  • step 302 may specifically include:
  • a first device obtains a service type according to a service currently used by the first device.
  • the first device acquires scene information according to a working scenario in which the first device is currently located.
  • the above step 303 may specifically include:
  • scenario information is a third working scenario and the service type is carrier aggregation CA service
  • the first device displays an eleventh network icon.
  • the first device displays a twelfth network icon.
  • the first device displays a thirteenth network icon.
  • the first device displays a fourteenth network icon.
  • the third working scenario may include: the first device is connected to the NR cell, or the first device resides in the NR cell.
  • the first device may display different network icons according to different services currently used.
  • the second communication system is a 5G system.
  • service types and network icons see Table 15.
  • the scene information obtained by the first device in step 302 is the third working scenario. If the first device determines that the service type includes a CA according to the currently used service, according to Table 15, the first device can know that the network icon corresponding to the third working scenario and the CA is a "5G-CA" icon, so the first device can display " 5G-CA "icon. If the first device is in the third working scenario, and the first device determines that the service type does not include CA, DC, and MINO according to the currently used service, the first device may display a 5G icon.
  • the above Table 15 is described by using the example that the first parameter information in the mapping information includes only the service type.
  • the first parameter information in the mapping information may further include service type and indication information, frequency information, operator information, or location information. combination.
  • the mapping information includes indication information and corresponding relationships between service types and network icons.
  • the indication information is 1-bit information, the indication information "1" indicates that the icon of the second communication system is displayed, and the indication information "0" indicates that the icon of the first communication system is displayed.
  • the second communication system is a 5G system
  • the first communication system is a 4G system.
  • Table 16 or Table 17 For the correspondence between the indication information and the service type and the network icon, see Table 16 or Table 17.
  • the mapping information includes a correspondence between scene information and a network icon
  • the m first parameter information acquired by the first device in step 302 includes scene information.
  • the above step 302 may include: the first device acquires scene information according to a working scenario in which the first device is currently located.
  • the above step 303 may include: when the scene information is the second working scene, the first device displays a network icon of the second communication system. That is, when the first device is registered in the core network of the second communication system through the air interface of the first communication system, the first device may display a network icon of the second communication system. For example, when the second communication system is a 5G system and the first communication system is a 4G system, if the first device is registered in the 5G core network through the 4G air interface, the first device may display a network icon of the 5G system.
  • first parameter information in the mapping information and the network icon involved in the display control method provided by the embodiment of the present application may also have other corresponding relationships.
  • the first parameter information in the mapping information may also be indication information, frequency information, service type, Other combinations of operator information and location information are not listed here.
  • the method may include:
  • the first device acquires detection information, where the detection information includes second parameter information, and the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of a neighboring cell of a cell where the first device is located.
  • the first device measures a signal of an adjacent cell according to the detection information.
  • the first device may directly measure the signals of the neighboring cell according to the measurement information of the neighboring cell of the cell where the first device is located in the acquired detection information, without first searching for the neighboring cell through blind search. Signal measurement is performed after measuring information such as frequency, thereby saving time and power consumption of the first device in full-frequency search and extending the working time of the first device.
  • the first device may intermittently measure signals of neighboring cells according to the time information in the acquired detection information, without performing real-time and continuous measurement, so that the power consumption of the first device may be further reduced.
  • the second parameter information may specifically include measurement information and time information of neighboring cells in the target communication system; and / or, measurement information and time information of high-frequency signals of neighboring cells in the target communication system.
  • obtaining the detection information by the first device may include: obtaining, by the first device, detection information pre-made on the first device. Specifically, similar to the mapping information, the detection information may be pre-made in a SIM card or a memory of the first device. In this way, when the detection information is prefabricated on the first device, the first device can conveniently, directly and intermittently measure signals of adjacent cells according to the prefabricated measurement information and time information to reduce the power consumption of the first device.
  • acquiring the detection information by the first device may include: acquiring, by the first device, detection information from a third device.
  • the third device may be the same device as the second device, for example, the third device may be a base station; or the third device may be a device different from the second device, for example, the third device may be a cloud server.
  • the first device acquiring the detection information from a device such as a cloud server can save the air interface signaling overhead of the base station.
  • the measurement method provided in the embodiment of the present application can also be applied to the process of the display control method described in the foregoing embodiment.
  • the method may further include :
  • the first device acquires detection information, where the detection information includes second parameter information, and the second parameter information includes at least one of measurement information or time information of a neighboring cell.
  • the first device measures a signal of an adjacent cell according to the detection information.
  • the first device controls the display of the network icon, it can directly measure the signals of the neighboring cells according to the measurement information of the neighboring cells of the cell where the first device is located in the acquired detection information, without first searching through blind search.
  • the signal measurement is performed after measuring information such as the frequency of the neighboring cell, so that the time and power consumption of the first device in the full frequency search can be saved, and the working time of the first device can be prolonged.
  • the first device may intermittently measure signals of neighboring cells according to the time information in the acquired detection information, without performing real-time and continuous measurement, so that the power consumption of the first device may be further reduced.
  • the frequency information in the m first parameter information in step 302 is used to indicate that the service frequency of the cell where the first device is located is a low-frequency signal, and whether the first device is There is high frequency signal coverage in the neighboring cell of the second communication system with the operator.
  • the first device After measuring the signal of the neighboring cell, in step 701, step 801, step 902, or step 1002, the first device measures the signal of the neighboring cell through the detection information to determine whether there is signal coverage of the neighboring cell, and It is determined whether there is high-frequency signal coverage of a neighboring cell of the second communication system with the operator.
  • the m first parameter information acquired by the first device is The frequency information is "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and is covered by the high-frequency signal of the neighboring cell of the second communication system with the operator.”
  • the first device may display an icon corresponding to the frequency information.
  • the target communication system may be a second communication system
  • the second parameter information may specifically include measurement information and time information of neighboring cells in the second communication system; and And / or measurement information and time information of high-frequency signals of neighboring cells in the second communication system.
  • the second parameter information includes measurement information and time information of neighboring cells in the second communication system
  • the second parameter information may include the NR phase of the cell where the first device is located. Measurement information and time information of neighboring cells.
  • the first device may directly measure high-frequency signals of neighboring cells in the second communication system according to the detection information to determine whether there is Coverage of high-frequency signals of adjacent cells in the second communication system, thereby facilitating the first device to obtain m of the above schemes (7) to (10) according to whether there is coverage of high-frequency signals of adjacent cells in the second communication system. Frequency information in the first parameter information.
  • the second parameter information in the detection information includes measurement information and time information of neighboring cells, and may specifically be measurement information and time information of neighboring cells in the second communication system that correspond to the same operator as the cell where the first device is located. Or, specifically, it may be measurement information and time information of a high frequency signal of a neighboring cell corresponding to the same operator as a cell where the first device is located in the second communication system. In this way, it is convenient for the first device to determine whether there is coverage of a high-frequency signal of a neighboring cell of the second communication system and the operator according to the detection information, thereby obtaining m first parameter information in the solutions of (7) to (10) above Frequency information.
  • the detection information may further include a correspondence between the second parameter information and at least one third parameter information, and the third parameter information includes operator information or location information. That is, the measurement information and time information of the signals of the neighboring cells are related to the operation information and / or location information. If the operation information and / or the position information are different, the measurement information and time information of the signals of the neighboring cells may also be different.
  • the operator information may be information such as a PLMN identity.
  • the location information may be a country code, a province code, or GPS positioning information.
  • the measurement information may include a serving frequency of the cell, a frequency band of the cell, or cell information.
  • the time information may be period information measured by the first device, or the time information may be applied to a timer.
  • the first device may obtain service frequencies of different operator cells, or obtain timers of different operator cells, or obtain service frequencies of different operator cells in different geographical locations, or obtain different The timers of the operator's cell in different geographical locations, etc., perform signal measurement based on the acquired information.
  • the period information may be the start time of the first measurement when the first device performs two adjacent measurements (that is, signals of adjacent cells).
  • the time information may be used for at least one of the following: the time information is used for the first device to measure when the timer expires, and the timer is started or restarted; or, the time information is used for the first device At the end of the measurement, the timer is started or restarted; or, the time information is used for the first device to start the timer after acquiring the detection information; or, the time information is used for the first device to perform the measurement after the acquisition information is obtained, and Start or restart the timer when starting a measurement, or start or restart the timer when ending a measurement.
  • the detection information includes the correspondence between the third parameter information and the second parameter information, the third parameter information includes location information and operator information; the second communication system is a 5G system, and the second parameter information includes the neighbor NR cell's
  • the detection information of the serving frequency, frequency band, and timer, and the serving frequency, frequency band, and timer of the high-frequency signal of the neighboring NR cell can be shown in Table 17.
  • the location information "US” indicates the United States
  • the location information "CHINA" indicates China.
  • the first device resides in an NR low-frequency (eg, ⁇ 6GHz) cell, and the operation information of the first device is PLMN1 If the location information of the first device is CHINA, the first device can find the service frequency, frequency band, and timer of the NR high-frequency signal corresponding to PLMN1 and CHINA in Table 18, as shown in the underlined identification section in Table 18. At this time, the first device may directly measure the high-frequency signal of the adjacent NR cell in the above (8) according to the service frequencies f1, f2; or according to the frequency bands band1, band2, thereby saving time and power consumption of full-frequency blind detection.
  • NR low-frequency eg, ⁇ 6GHz
  • the first device may directly measure the high-frequency signal of the adjacent NR cell in the above (8) according to the timer 3, thereby avoiding high power consumption caused by real-time measurement.
  • the first device measures according to the service frequency f1, f2 or the frequency bands band1, band2, and timer 3 to determine that it is covered by a high-frequency signal (e.g., ⁇ 6GHz) of a neighboring cell that is operated by the second communication system
  • the first device is in
  • the frequency information in the m first parameter information obtained in step 302 is "the service frequency is a low-frequency signal, and is covered by a high-frequency signal in a neighboring cell of the same system and the same operator.”
  • the first device may display the "5G +" icon corresponding to frequency information.
  • the first device includes hardware and / or software modules corresponding to performing each function.
  • the present application can be implemented in the form of hardware or a combination of hardware and computer software. Whether a certain function is performed by hardware or computer software-driven hardware depends on the specific application of the technical solution and design constraints. Those skilled in the art can use different methods to implement the described functions for each specific application in combination with the embodiments, but such implementation should not be considered to be beyond the scope of the present application.
  • the first device may be divided into function modules according to the foregoing method example.
  • each function module may be divided corresponding to each function, or two or more functions may be integrated into one processing module.
  • the above integrated modules may be implemented in the form of hardware. It should be noted that the division of the modules in the embodiments of the present application is schematic, and is only a logical function division. In actual implementation, there may be another division manner.
  • FIG. 10 shows a possible composition diagram of the first device 1400 involved in the foregoing embodiment.
  • the first device 1400 may include: The first acquisition unit 1401, the second acquisition unit 1402, the third acquisition unit 1403, the display unit 1404, and the measurement unit 1405.
  • the first obtaining unit 1401, the second obtaining unit 1402, and the third obtaining unit 1403 may be three independent modules or a whole obtaining module, which are not specifically limited in the embodiment of the present application.
  • the first obtaining unit 1401 may be configured to support the first device 1400 to perform the foregoing steps 301 and the like, and / or other processes used in the technology described herein.
  • the second obtaining unit 1402 may be used to support the first device 1400 to perform the steps 501-510, steps 601-602, steps 701-702, steps 801-803, steps 901-903, steps 1401-1404, and steps 1101-1102 , And / or other processes for the techniques described herein.
  • the display unit 1404 can be used to support the first device 1400 to perform the above steps 503-504, steps 603-604, steps 703-704, steps 804-807, steps 904-905, steps 1405-1408, steps 1103-1106, and the like, and / Or other processes for the techniques described herein.
  • the third obtaining unit 1403 may be used to support the first device 1400 to perform the above-mentioned step 1301, and / or other processes for the technology described herein.
  • the measurement unit 1405 may be used to support the first device 1400 to perform the above steps 1302, and / or other processes for the techniques described herein.
  • the first device provided in the embodiment of the present application is configured to execute the foregoing implementation method of displaying service information in a preview interface, and thus the same effect as the foregoing implementation method can be achieved.
  • the first device may include a processing module and a storage module.
  • the processing module may be used to control and manage the actions of the first device.
  • the processing module may be used to support the first device to execute the first obtaining unit 1401, the second obtaining unit 1402, the third obtaining unit 1403, the display unit 1404, and Steps performed by the measurement unit 1405.
  • the storage module may be used to support the first device to store mapping information, detection information, and to store program code and data.
  • the first device may further include a communication module, which may be used to support communication between the first device and other devices.
  • the processing module may control the communication module to obtain mapping information or detection information from other devices.
  • the processing module may be a processor or a controller. It may implement or execute various exemplary logical blocks, modules, and circuits described in connection with the present disclosure.
  • the processor may also be a combination that implements computing functions, such as a combination including one or more microprocessors, a combination of digital signal processing (DSP) and a microprocessor, and so on.
  • the memory module may be a memory.
  • the communication module may specifically be a device that interacts with other first devices, such as a radio frequency circuit, a Bluetooth chip, and a wifi chip.
  • the first device involved in the embodiment of the present application may be a device having a structure shown in FIG. 2.
  • An embodiment of the present application further provides a computer storage medium.
  • the computer storage medium stores computer instructions, and when the computer instructions are run on the first device, the first device executes the related method steps to implement the display in the foregoing embodiment. Control Method.
  • the embodiment of the present application further provides a computer program product, when the computer program product is run on a computer, the computer is caused to execute the foregoing related steps, so as to implement the display control method in the preview interface in the foregoing embodiment.
  • an embodiment of the present application further provides a device.
  • the device may specifically be a chip, a component, or a module.
  • the device may include a connected processor and a memory.
  • the memory is used to store a computer to execute instructions.
  • the processor may execute computer execution instructions stored in the memory, so that the chip executes the display control method in the foregoing method embodiments.
  • the first device, computer storage medium, computer program product, or chip provided in the embodiments of the present application are used to execute the corresponding methods provided above. Therefore, for the beneficial effects that can be achieved, reference may be made to the foregoing. The beneficial effects in the corresponding method are not repeated here.
  • the disclosed apparatus and method may be implemented in other ways.
  • the device embodiments described above are only schematic.
  • the division of modules or units is only a logical function division.
  • multiple units or components may be combined or It can be integrated into another device, or some features can be ignored or not implemented.
  • the displayed or discussed mutual coupling or direct coupling or communication connection may be indirect coupling or communication connection through some interfaces, devices or units, which may be electrical, mechanical or other forms.
  • the units described as separate components may or may not be physically separated, and the components displayed as units may be one physical unit or multiple physical units, that is, they may be located in one place, or may be distributed in multiple different places. Some or all of the units may be selected according to actual needs to achieve the objective of the solution of this embodiment.
  • each functional unit in each embodiment of the present application may be integrated into one processing unit, or each of the units may exist separately physically, or two or more units may be integrated into one unit.
  • the above integrated unit may be implemented in the form of hardware or in the form of software functional unit.
  • the integrated unit When the integrated unit is implemented in the form of a software functional unit and sold or used as an independent product, it can be stored in a readable storage medium.
  • the technical solution of the embodiments of the present application is essentially a part that contributes to the existing technology or all or part of the technical solution may be embodied in the form of a software product that is stored in a storage medium.
  • the instructions include a number of instructions for causing a device (which can be a single-chip microcomputer, a chip, or the like) or a processor to execute all or part of the steps of the methods in the embodiments of the present application.
  • the foregoing storage medium includes: a U disk, a mobile hard disk, a read-only memory (ROM), a random access memory (RAM), a magnetic disk or an optical disk, and other media that can store program codes.

Landscapes

  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Theoretical Computer Science (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Human Computer Interaction (AREA)
  • Quality & Reliability (AREA)
  • Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
  • Signal Processing (AREA)
  • Environmental & Geological Engineering (AREA)
  • Telephone Function (AREA)
  • User Interface Of Digital Computer (AREA)

Abstract

本申请实施例提供一种显示控制方法及设备,涉及通信技术领域,能够灵活显示网络图标。具体方案为:第一设备获取映射信息,映射信息包括多个对应关系,多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态inactive或连接态;第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n等正整数;第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。本申请实施例用于显示网络图标。

Description

一种显示控制方法及设备 技术领域
本申请实施例涉及通信技术领域,尤其涉及一种显示控制方法及设备。。
背景技术
终端在开机后,通过与移动通信网络的核心网交互附着信息来注册移动通信网络。网络注册成功后,终端就驻留或工作在所注册的网络下,并且在状态栏中显示所注册的网络的图标。若所注册的网络未发生变化,则终端显示的网络图标也不会发生变化;在所注册的网络电网终端重新注册到另一网络后,终端才显示另一网络的图标。
例如,当终端注册到第四代移动通信技术(the 4th generation mobile communication technology,4G)网络时,终端可以在状态栏中显示“4G”图标。在4G网络掉网之前,终端保持显示“4G”图标。在4G网络掉网,终端回落到第三代移动通信技术(3rd-generation mobile communication technology,3G)网络后,终端将“4G”图标更新为“3G”图标。
发明内容
本申请实施例提供一种显示控制方法及设备,能够灵活地显示网络图标。
为达到上述目的,本申请实施例采用如下技术方案:
第一方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种显示控制方法,包括:第一设备获取映射信息,映射信息包括多个对应关系,多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态inactive或连接态。第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n等正整数。第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据从第二设备获取到的或根据第一设备的工作状态获取到的不同的第一参数信息,动态地显示不同的网络图标,而并不像现有技术那样仅能保持显示第一设备所注册的网络的图标,因而能够灵活地对网络图标的显示进行控制,更为方便地满足运营商的运维需求。
结合第一方面,在第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式中,场景信息包括:第一工作场景,第一设备所在的小区为第一通信系统的小区且支持与第二通信系统的联合组网;或者,第二工作场景,第一设备通过第一通信系统的空口注册在第二通信系统的核心网;或者,第三工作场景,第一设备所在的小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,第四工作场景,第一设备连接在第一通信系统的基站,且第一设备具有第二通信系统的辅基站。其中,第三工作场景包括:第一设备处于连接态时的服务小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,第一设备处于空闲态或非激活态时的驻留小区为第二通信系统的小区。
这样,根据不同的工作场景下,第一设备可以显示不同的网络图标。
结合第一方面的第一种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第二种可能的实现方式中,第一设备的工作状态包括:第一设备所在小区的服务频率,第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率,第一设备当前所使用的服务,第一设备当前所使用的运营商,第一设备当前所在的位置,第一设备当前所处的连接状态,或第一设备当前所处的工作场景。
这样,第一设备可以根据第一设备当前的工作状态获取第一参数信息。
结合第一方面或第一方面的第一或第二种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第三种可能的实现方式中, 指示信息为第一设备从第二设备接收到的广播信息。
这样,第一设备可以根据从第二设备接收到的广播信息获取指示信息,从而根据指示信息控制网络图标的显示。
结合第一方面或第一方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第四种可能的实现方式中,运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络(public land mobile network,PLMN)标识。
这样,第一设备可以根据PLMN标识控制网络图标的显示。
结合第一方面或第一方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第五种可能的实现方式中,位置信息包括国家代码、省市代码或全球定位系统(global positioning system,GPS)信息中的至少一种。
这样,第一设备可以根据国家代码、省市代码或全球定位系统GPS信息控制网络图标的显示。
结合第一方面或第一方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第六种可能的实现方式中,服务类型包括载波聚合(carrier aggregation,CA)服务、双连接(dual connectivity,DC)服务或多输入多出(multiple input multiple output,MIMO)服务中的至少一种。
这样,第一设备可以根据第一设备所使用的服务的不同类型显示不同的网络图标。
结合第一方面或第一方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第七种可能的实现方式中,第一设备获取映射信息,包括:第一设备获取第一设备上预制的映射信息;或者,第一设备从第三设备获取映射信息,第三设备与第二设备不同。
也就是说,第一设备可以从第一设备本身或者从第三设备获取预先设置的映射信息。
结合第一方面的第七种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第八种可能的实现方式中,第一设备获取第一设备上预制的映射信息,包括:第一设备获取第一设备的用户身份识别模块(subscriber identification module,SIM)卡中预制的映射信息;或者,获取第一设备的存储器中预制的映射信息。
也就是说,映射信息可以预先设置在第一设备的SIM卡或存储器中。
结合第一方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第九种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息和频率信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,包括:第一设备从第二设备接收指示信息;第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取频率信息。第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标;若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取到的指示信息和频率信息,从映射信息中查找对应的目标网络图标,从而显示该目标网络图标。
结合第一方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第十种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,包括:第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取频率信息;第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:当场景信息为第三工作场景或第四工作场景时,若频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标。若频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取到的频率信息和场景信息,从映射信息中查找对应的目标网络图标,从而显示该目标网络图标。
结合第一方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第十一种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,包括:第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:当场景信息为第三工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第一网络图标;若频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二网络图标。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取到的频率信息和场景信息,从映射信息中查找对应的目标网络图标,从而显示该目标网络图标。
结合第一方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第十二种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,包括:第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;第一设备根据当前所处的连接状态获取连接状态信息;第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:当场景信息为第三工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第三网络图标;若连接状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第四网络图标;若连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第五网络图标;若连接状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第六网络图标。其中,第三网络图标、第四网络图标、第五网络图标和第六网络图标可以相同或不同。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取到的频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息,从映射信息中查找对应的目标网络图标,从而显示该目标网络图标。
结合第一方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第十三种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、频率信息和场景信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,包括:第一设备从第二设备接收指示信息;第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:当指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频 率为低频信号时,若频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标;若频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取到的指示信息、频率信息和场景信息,从映射信息中查找对应的目标网络图标,从而显示该目标网络图标。
结合第一方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第十四种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,包括:第一设备从第二设备接收指示信息;第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;第一设备根据当前所处的连接状态获取连接状态信息;第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:当场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第七网络图标;若状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第八网络图标;若状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第九网络图标;若状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第十网络图标。其中,第七网络图标、第八网络图标、第九网络图标和第十网络图标可以相同或不同。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取到的指示信息、频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息,从映射信息中查找对应的目标网络图标,从而显示该目标网络图标。
结合第一方面的第十一至第十四种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式中,在第一设备获取频率信息之前,方法还包括:第一设备获取检测信息,检测信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;第一设备根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
这样,第一设备在进行网络图标的显示控制时,可以根据获取的检测信息中第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息,直接测量相邻小区的信号,而不需要通过盲搜先搜索到相邻小区的频率等测量信息后再进行信号测量,因而可以节省第一设备在全频搜索的时间和功耗,延长第一设备的工作时长。并且,第一设备可以根据获取的检测信息中的时间信息,间歇性地测量相邻小区的信号,而不用实时地、持续地进行测量,因而可以进一步降低第一设备的功耗。
结合第一方面的第十五种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第十六种可能的实现方式中,第二参数信息包括第二通信系统的小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
结合第一方面的第十五或第十六种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第十七种可能的实现方式中,第一设备获取检测信息,包括:第一设备获取第一设备上预制的检测信息;或者,第一设备从第三设备获取检测信息。
这样,第一设备可以根据从第一设备或从第三设备上获取的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间 信息,直接测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第一方面的第十五至第十七种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第十八种可能的实现方式中,检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
这样,第一设备可以根据不同运营商信息或位置信息对应的相邻小区的不同测量信息或时间信息,测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第一方面的第十五至第十八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第十九种可能的实现方式中,测量信息包括小区的频率信息或小区信息。
这样,第一设备可以根据相邻小区的测量信息中小区的频率信息或小区信息测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第一方面的第十五至第十九种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第二十种可能的实现方式中,时间信息是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,周期信息为第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
这样,第一设备可以根据检测信息中的周期信息测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第一方面的第十五至第二十种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第二十一种可能的实现方式中,时间信息应用于定时器,时间信息用于以下至少一项:时间信息用于第一设备在定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在发生小区重选时,重置或停止或取消定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在接收到第二设备发送的第二消息后,开启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在接收到第二设备发送的第二消息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启定时器。
这样,第一设备可以根据检测信息中的定时器信息测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第一方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第二十二种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括服务类型和场景信息;第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,包括:第一设备根据第一设备当前所使用的服务获取服务类型;第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息;第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:当场景信息为第三工作场景时,若服务类型为载波聚合CA服务,则第一设备显示第十一网络图标;若服务类型为双连接DC服务,则第一设备显示第十二网络图标;若服务类型为多入多出MIMO服务,则第一设备显示第十三网络图标;否则,第一设备显示第十四网络图标。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取到的场景信息和服务类型,从映射信息中查找对应的目标网络图标,从而显示该目标网络图标。
结合第一方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第一方面的第二十三种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括场景信息,第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,包括:第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:当场景信息为第二工作场景时,第一设备显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取到的场景信息,从映射信息中查找对应的目标网络图标,从而显示该目标网络图标。
结合第一方面或第一方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第一方面的第二十四种可能的实现方式中,第一通信系统为4G系统,第二通信系统为(5th-generation mobile communication technology,5G)系统。
这样,第一设备可以显示5G系统的网络图标或4G系统的网络图标。
第二方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种测量方法,包括:第一设备获取检测信息,检测信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种。第一设备根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
在该方案中,第一设备可以根据获取的检测信息中第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息,直接测量相邻小区的信号,而不需要通过盲搜先搜索到相邻小区的频率等测量信息后再进行信号测量,因而可以节省第一设备在全频搜索的时间和功耗,延长第一设备的工作时长。并且,第一设备可以根据获取的检测信息中的时间信息,间歇性地测量相邻小区的信号,而不用实时地、持续地进行测量,因而可以进一步降低第一设备的功耗。
结合第二方面,在第二方面的第一种可能的实现方式中,第二参数信息包括目标通信系统中相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,目标通信系统中的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
结合第二方面或第二方面的第一种可能的实现方式,在第二方面的第二种可能的实现方式中,第一设备获取检测信息,包括:第一设备获取第一设备上预制的检测信息;或者,第一设备从第三设备获取检测信息。
结合第二方面或第二方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第二方面的第二种可能的设计中,检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
结合第二方面或第二方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第二方面的第三种可能的设计中,运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;位置信息包括国家代码或省市代码或GPS定位信息中的至少一种。
结合第二方面或第二方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第二方面的第四种可能的设计中,测量信息包括小区的频率信息或小区信息。
结合第二方面或第二方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第二方面的第五种可能的设计中,时间信息是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,周期信息为第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
结合第二方面或第二方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第二方面的第六种可能的设计中,时间信息应用于定时器,时间信息用于以下至少一项:时间信息用于第一设备在定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在获取到检测信息后,开启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在获取到进行信息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启定时器。
第三方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种第一设备,包括:第一获取单元,用于获取映射信息,映射信息包括多个对应关系,多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态inactive或连接态。第二获取单元,用于从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n等正整数。显示单元,用于根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。
结合第三方面,在第三方面的第一种可能的实现方式中,场景信息包括:第一工作场景,第一设备所在的小区为第一通信系统的小区且支持与第二通信系统的联合组网;或者,第二工作场景,第一设备通过第一通信系统的空口注册在第二通信系统的核心网;或者,第三工作场景,第一设备所在的小区为 第二通信系统的小区;或者,第四工作场景,第一设备连接在第一通信系统的基站,且第一设备具有第二通信系统的辅基站。其中,第三工作场景包括:第一设备处于连接态时的服务小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,第一设备处于空闲态或非激活态时的驻留小区为第二通信系统的小区。
结合第三方面的第一种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第二种可能的实现方式中,第一设备的工作状态包括:第一设备所在小区的服务频率,第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率,第一设备当前所使用的服务,第一设备当前所使用的运营商,第一设备当前所在的位置,第一设备当前所处的连接状态,或第一设备当前所处的工作场景。
结合第三方面或第三方面的第一或第二种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第三种可能的实现方式中,指示信息为第一设备从第二设备接收到的广播信息。
结合第三方面或第三方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第四种可能的实现方式中,运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识。
结合第三方面或第三方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第五种可能的实现方式中,位置信息包括国家代码、省市代码或全球定位系统GPS信息中的至少一种。
结合第三方面或第三方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第六种可能的实现方式中,服务类型包括载波聚合CA服务、双连接DC服务或多输入多出MIMO服务中的至少一种。
结合第三方面或第三方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第七种可能的实现方式中,第一获取单元具体用于:获取第一设备上预制的映射信息;或者,从第三设备获取映射信息,第三设备与第二设备不同。
结合第三方面的第七种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第八种可能的实现方式中,第一获取单元具体用于:获取第一设备的用户身份识别模块SIM卡中预制的映射信息;或者,获取第一设备的存储器中预制的映射信息。
结合第三方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第九种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息和频率信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第二获取单元具体用于:从第二设备接收指示信息;根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取频率信息。显示单元具体用于:若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标;若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
结合第三方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第十种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第二获取单元具体用于:根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取频率信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示单元具体用于:当场景信息为第三工作场景或第四工作场景时,若频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标。若频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
结合第三方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第十一种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第二获取单元具体用于:根据第一设备所在小区的 服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示单元具体用于:当场景信息为第三工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第一网络图标;若频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二网络图标。
结合第三方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第十二种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第二获取单元具体用于:根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;根据当前所处的连接状态获取连接状态信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示单元具体用于:当场景信息为第三工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第三网络图标;若连接状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第四网络图标;若连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第五网络图标;若连接状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第六网络图标。其中,第三网络图标、第四网络图标、第五网络图标和第六网络图标可以相同或不同。
结合第三方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第十三种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、频率信息和场景信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第二获取单元具体用于:从第二设备接收指示信息;根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示单元具体用于:当指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标;若频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
结合第三方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第十四种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。第二获取单元具体用于:从第二设备接收指示信息;根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;根据当前所处的连接状态获取连接状态信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示单元具体用于:当场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第七网络图标;若状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显 示第二通信系统的第八网络图标;若状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第九网络图标;若状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第十网络图标。其中,第七网络图标、第八网络图标、第九网络图标和第十网络图标可以相同或不同。
结合第三方面的第十一至第十四种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第十五种可能的实现方式中,第一设备还包括第三获取单元和测量单元。第三获取单元用于,在第二获取单元获取频率信息之前获取检测信息,检测信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种。测量单元用于,根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第三方面的第十五种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第十六种可能的实现方式中,第二参数信息包括第二通信系统的小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
结合第三方面的第十五或第十六种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第十七种可能的实现方式中,第三获取单元具体用于:获取第一设备上预制的检测信息;或者,第一设备从第三设备获取检测信息。
结合第三方面的第十五至第十七种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第十八种可能的实现方式中,检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
结合第三方面的第十五至第十八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第十九种可能的实现方式中,测量信息包括小区的频率信息或小区信息。
结合第三方面的第十五至第十九种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第二十种可能的实现方式中,时间信息是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,周期信息为第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
结合第三方面的第十五至第二十种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第二十一种可能的实现方式中,时间信息应用于定时器,时间信息用于以下至少一项:时间信息用于第一设备在定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在发生小区重选时,重置或停止或取消定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在接收到第二设备发送的第二消息后,开启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在接收到第二设备发送的第二消息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启定时器。
结合第三方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第二十二种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括服务类型和场景信息。第二获取单元具体用于:根据第一设备当前所使用的服务获取服务类型;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示单元具体用于:当场景信息为第三工作场景时,若服务类型为载波聚合CA服务,则显示第十一网络图标;若服务类型为双连接DC服务,则显示第十二网络图标;若服务类型为多入多出MIMO服务,则显示第十三网络图标;否则,显示第十四网络图标。
结合第三方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第三方面的第二十三种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括场景信息。第二获取单元具体用于:根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示单元具体用于:当场景信息为第二工作场景时,显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
结合第三方面或第三方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第三方面的第二十四种可能的实现方式中, 第一通信系统为4G系统,第二通信系统为5G系统。
第四方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种电子设备,包括:检测单元,用于获取检测信息,检测信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种。测量单元,用于根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第四方面,在第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式中,第二参数信息包括目标通信系统中相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,目标通信系统中的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
结合第四方面或第四方面的第一种可能的实现方式,在第四方面的第二种可能的实现方式中,获取单元具体用于:获取第一设备上预制的检测信息;或者,从第三设备获取检测信息。
结合第四方面或第四方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第四方面的第二种可能的设计中,检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
结合第四方面或第四方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第四方面的第三种可能的设计中,运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;位置信息包括国家代码或省市代码或GPS定位信息中的至少一种。
结合第四方面或第四方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第四方面的第四种可能的设计中,测量信息包括小区的频率信息或小区信息。
结合第四方面或第四方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第四方面的第五种可能的设计中,时间信息是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,周期信息为第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
结合第四方面或第四方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第四方面的第六种可能的设计中,时间信息应用于定时器,时间信息用于以下至少一项:时间信息用于第一设备在定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在获取到检测信息后,开启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在获取到进行信息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启定时器。
第五方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种第一设备,包括显示屏、一个或多个处理器和一个或多个存储器;显示屏、一个或多个存储器与一个或多个处理器耦合,一个或多个存储器用于存储计算机程序代码,计算机程序代码包括计算机指令,当一个或多个处理器执行计算机指令时,处理器用于,获取映射信息,映射信息包括多个对应关系,多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态inactive或连接态;从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n等正整数。显示屏用于,根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。
结合第五方面,在第五方面的第一种可能的实现方式中,场景信息包括:第一工作场景,第一设备所在的小区为第一通信系统的小区且支持与第二通信系统的联合组网;或者,第二工作场景,第一设备通过第一通信系统的空口注册在第二通信系统的核心网;或者,第三工作场景,第一设备所在的小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,第四工作场景,第一设备连接在第一通信系统的基站,且第一设备具有第二通信系统的辅基站。其中,第三工作场景包括:第一设备处于连接态时的服务小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,第一设备处于空闲态或非激活态时的驻留小区为第二通信系统的小区。
结合第五方面的第一种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第二种可能的实现方式中,第一设备的工作 状态包括:第一设备所在小区的服务频率,第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率,第一设备当前所使用的服务,第一设备当前所使用的运营商,第一设备当前所在的位置,第一设备当前所处的连接状态,或第一设备当前所处的工作场景。
结合第五方面或第五方面的第一或第二种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第三种可能的实现方式中,指示信息为第一设备从第二设备接收到的广播信息。
结合第五方面或第五方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第四种可能的实现方式中,运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识。
结合第五方面或第五方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第五种可能的实现方式中,位置信息包括国家代码、省市代码或全球定位系统GPS信息中的至少一种。
结合第五方面或第五方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第六种可能的实现方式中,服务类型包括载波聚合CA服务、双连接DC服务或多输入多出MIMO服务中的至少一种。
结合第五方面或第五方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第七种可能的实现方式中,处理器具体用于:获取第一设备上预制的映射信息;或者,从第三设备获取映射信息,第三设备与第二设备不同。
结合第五方面的第七种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第八种可能的实现方式中,处理器具体用于:获取第一设备的用户身份识别模块SIM卡中预制的映射信息;或者,获取第一设备的存储器中预制的映射信息。
结合第五方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第九种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息和频率信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。处理器具体用于:从第二设备接收指示信息;根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取频率信息。显示屏具体用于:若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标;若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
结合第五方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第十种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。处理器具体用于:根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取频率信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示屏具体用于:当场景信息为第三工作场景或第四工作场景时,若频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标。若频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
结合第五方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第十一种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。处理器具体用于:根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示屏具体用于:当场景信息为第三工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第一网络图标;若频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二网络图标。
结合第五方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第十二种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。处理器具体用于:根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;根据当前所处的连接状态获取连接状态信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示屏具体用于:当场景信息为第三工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第三网络图标;若连接状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第四网络图标;若连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第五网络图标;若连接状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第六网络图标。其中,第三网络图标、第四网络图标、第五网络图标和第六网络图标可以相同或不同。
结合第五方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第十三种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、频率信息和场景信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。处理器具体用于:从第二设备接收指示信息;根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示屏具体用于:当指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标;若频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
结合第五方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第十四种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。处理器具体用于:从第二设备接收指示信息;根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息;根据当前所处的连接状态获取连接状态信息;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示屏具体用于:当场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第七网络图标;若状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第八网络图标;若状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第九网络图标;若状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第二通信系统的第十网络图标。其中,第七网络图标、第八网络图标、第九网络图标和第十网络图标可以相同或不同。
结合第五方面的第十一至第十四种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第十五种可能的实现方式中,第一设备还包括第三获取单元,用于在第二获取单元获取频率信息之前获取检测信息,检测 信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;第一设备根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第五方面的第十五种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第十六种可能的实现方式中,第二参数信息包括第二通信系统的小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
结合第五方面的第十五或第十六种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第十七种可能的实现方式中,第三获取单元具体用于:获取第一设备上预制的检测信息;或者,第一设备从第三设备获取检测信息。
结合第五方面的第十五至第十七种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第十八种可能的实现方式中,检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
结合第五方面的第十五至第十八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第十九种可能的实现方式中,测量信息包括小区的频率信息或小区信息。
结合第五方面的第十五至第十九种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第二十种可能的实现方式中,时间信息是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,周期信息为第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
结合第五方面的第十五至第二十种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第二十一种可能的实现方式中,时间信息应用于定时器,时间信息用于以下至少一项:时间信息用于第一设备在定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在发生小区重选时,重置或停止或取消定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在接收到第二设备发送的第二消息后,开启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在接收到第二设备发送的第二消息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启定时器。
结合第五方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第二十二种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括服务类型和场景信息。处理器具体用于:根据第一设备当前所使用的服务获取服务类型;根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示屏具体用于:当场景信息为第三工作场景时,若服务类型为载波聚合CA服务,则显示第十一网络图标;若服务类型为双连接DC服务,则显示第十二网络图标;若服务类型为多入多出MIMO服务,则显示第十三网络图标;否则,显示第十四网络图标。
结合第五方面的第二种至第八种可能的实现方式中的任意一种,在第五方面的第二十三种可能的实现方式中,m个第一参数信息包括场景信息。处理器具体用于:根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。显示屏具体用于:当场景信息为第二工作场景时,显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
结合第五方面或第五方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第五方面的第二十四种可能的实现方式中,第一通信系统为4G系统,第二通信系统为5G系统。
第六方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种电子设备,包括一个或多个处理器和一个或多个存储器;显示屏、一个或多个存储器与一个或多个处理器耦合,一个或多个存储器用于存储计算机程序代码,计算机程序代码包括计算机指令,当一个或多个处理器执行计算机指令时,处理器用于,获取检测信息,检测信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种。而后,根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
结合第六方面,在第六方面的第一种可能的实现方式中,第二参数信息包括目标通信系统中相邻小 区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,目标通信系统中的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
结合第六方面或第六方面的第一种可能的实现方式,在第六方面的第二种可能的实现方式中,处理器具体用于:获取第一设备上预制的检测信息;或者,从第三设备获取检测信息。
结合第六方面或第六方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第六方面的第二种可能的设计中,检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
结合第六方面或第六方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第六方面的第三种可能的设计中,运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;位置信息包括国家代码或省市代码或GPS定位信息中的至少一种。
结合第六方面或第六方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第六方面的第四种可能的设计中,测量信息包括小区的频率信息或小区信息。
结合第六方面或第六方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第六方面的第五种可能的设计中,时间信息是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,周期信息为第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
结合第六方面或第六方面任意一种可能的实现方式,在第六方面的第六种可能的设计中,时间信息应用于定时器,时间信息用于以下至少一项:时间信息用于第一设备在定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在获取到检测信息后,开启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在获取到进行信息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启定时器。
第七方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种电子设备,包括一个或多个处理器和一个或多个存储器。该一个或多个存储器与一个或多个处理器耦合,一个或多个存储器用于存储计算机程序代码,计算机程序代码包括计算机指令,当一个或多个处理器执行计算机指令时,使得电子设备执行上述任一方面任一项可能的实现中的显示控制方法或测量方法。
另一方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种计算机存储介质,包括计算机指令,当计算机指令在电子设备上运行时,使得电子设备执行上述任一方面任一项可能的实现中的显示控制方法或测量方法。
另一方面,本申请技术方案提供了一种计算机程序产品,当计算机程序产品在电子设备上运行时,使得电子设备执行上述任一方面任一项可能的设计中的显示控制方法或测量方法。
附图说明
图1为本申请实施例提供的一种系统架构示意图;
图2为本申请实施例提供的一种通信装置的结构示意图;
图3为本申请实施例提供的一种方法流程图;
图4为本申请实施例提供的一种网络图标的显示示意图;
图5为本申请实施例提供的另一种方法流程图;
图6为本申请实施例提供的另一种方法流程图;
图7为本申请实施例提供的另一种方法流程图;
图8为本申请实施例提供的另一种方法流程图;
图9为本申请实施例提供的一种周期信息的示意图;
图10为本申请实施例提供的一种第一设备的结构示意图。
具体实施方式
下面结合附图和实施例对本申请进行进一步描述。
为了便于理解,示例的给出了部分与本申请实施例相关概念的说明以供参考。如下所示:
系统信息:即系统信息块(system information block,SIB),SIB的调度信息,通过主信息块(master information block,MIB)或调度块(scheduling Block,SB)承载。SIB包含的信息可以包括:非接入层(non-access stratum,NAS)的系统信息,终端定时器/计数器,用于小区选择和重选的参数,用于小区公共物理信道配置的参数,测量控制信息,空闲与连接态时临近小区的公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识,以及不同系统小区间的频率和优先级等。
国家代码:也称国家编码,是一组用来代表国家和境外领土的地理代码。他是由字母或数字组成的短字串,方便用于数据处理和通讯。国家代码标准有多种,例如可以是国际标准化组织的ISO 3166-1。国家代码也可以指国际长途电话国家号码,即国际电信联盟的国际电话区号(E.164)。
运营商:指提供网络服务的供应商,例如中国联通、中国电信、中国移动、中国广电、美国AT&T等。
下面将结合本申请实施例中的附图,对本申请实施例中的技术方案进行描述。其中,在本申请实施例的描述中,除非另有说明,“/”表示或的意思,例如,A/B可以表示A或B;本文中的“和/或”仅仅是一种描述关联对象的关联关系,表示可以存在三种关系,例如,A和/或B,可以表示:单独存在A,同时存在A和B,单独存在B这三种情况。另外,在本申请实施例的描述中,“多个”是指两个或多于两个。
本申请实施例提供的显示控制方法及设备可以应用于如图1所示的系统架构。在图1所示的架构中,第一设备101可以与第一通信系统110中的第二设备102连接,并通过第二设备接入核心(core)网。第一设备101的临近区域可能还部署有第二通信系统120的小区和设备。第一通信系统110与第二通信系统120还可以联合组网,以为第一设备101提供双连接DC服务。其中,第一通信系统110与第二通信系统120不同,例如,第一通信系统110可以是4G系统,第二通信系统120可以是5G系统;或者,第一通信系统110可以是5G系统,第二通信系统120可以是5G之后演进的未来公共陆地移动网络PLMN系统。再例如,第一通信系统110可以是5G系统,第二通信系统120可以是4G系统;或者,第一通信系统110可以是5G之后演进的未来PLMN系统,第二通信系统120可以是5G系统。本申请实施例对第一通信系统110和第二通信系统120具体为哪种通信系统不作具体限定。
其中,第一设备101可以是终端,具体可以是用户设备(user equipment,UE)、接入终端、终端单元、终端站、移动站、移动台、远方站、远程终端、移动设备、无线通信设备、终端代理或终端装置等。接入终端可以是蜂窝电话、无绳电话、会话启动协议(session initiation protocol,SIP)电话、无线本地环路(wireless local loop,WLL)站、个人数字处理(personal digital assistant,PDA)、电脑、膝上型计算机、手持式计算设备、和/或用于在无线系统上进行通信的其他设备。具有无线通信功能的手持设备、计算设备或连接到无线调制解调器的其他处理设备、卫星无线设备、无线调制解调器卡、电视机顶盒(set top box,STB)、用户驻地设备(customer premise equipment,CPE)、车载设备、可穿戴设备,5G网络中的终端或者未来演进的PLMN网络中的终端等。
第二设备102可以是通信系统中的接入网设备。例如,该接入网设备可以是基站、中继站或接入点等。基站可以是全球移动通信系统(global system for mobile communication,GSM)或码分多址(code division multiple access,CDMA)网络中的基站收发信台(base transceiver station,BTS),也可以是宽带码分多址(wideband code division multiple access,WCDMA)中的NB(NodeB),还可以是LTE中的eNB或eNodeB(evolutional NodeB)。该接入网设备还可以是云无线接入网络(cloud radio access network, CRAN)场景下的无线控制器。该接入网设备还可以是5G网络中的下一代基站gNB或未来演进的PLMN系统中的接入网设备等。
示例性的,图2给出了一种通信装置200的结构示意图,该通信装置200可以是本申请实施例涉及的第一设备和第二设备,具体可以是芯片,基站,终端或者其他网络设备。
通信装置200包括一个或多个处理器201。处理器201可以是通用处理器或者专用处理器等。例如可以是基带处理器、或中央处理器。基带处理器可以用于对通信协议以及通信数据进行处理,中央处理器可以用于对通信装置200(如,基站、终端、或芯片等)进行控制,执行软件程序,处理软件程序的数据。
在一种可能的设计中,网络设备可以包括一个或者多个模块,该一个或多个模块可能由一个或者多个处理器来实现,或者一个或者多个处理器和存储器来实现。
在一种可能的设计中,通信装置200包括一个或多个处理器201,一个或多个处理器201可实现同频、异频、异系统测量以及显示通信系统信息的功能。在另一种可能的设计中,处理器201还可以实现其他功能。
可选的,在一种设计中,处理器201可以包括指令203(有时也可以称为代码或程序),指令可以在处理器上被运行,使得通信装置200执行本申请实施例中描述的方法。在又一种可能的设计中,通信装置200也可以包括电路,电路可以实现本申请实施例中的异系统测量和显示通信系统信息等功能。
可选的,在一种设计中,通信装置200中可以包括一个或多个存储器202,其上存有指令204,指令可在处理器上被运行,使得通信装置200执行上述方法实施例中描述的方法。
可选的,存储器中还可以存储有数据。可选的处理器中也可以存储指令和/或数据。处理器和存储器可以单独设置,也可以集成在一起。
可选的,通信装置200还可以包括收发器205以及天线206。处理器201可以称为处理单元,对通信装置200(终端或者基站)进行控制。收发器205可以称为收发单元、收发机、收发电路等,用于通过天线206实现通信装置的收发功能。
可选的,通信装置200还可以包括用于异频测量的调制解调模块(modem)等。可以通过一个或多个处理器201实现这些器件的功能。
可选的,通信装置200还可以包括显示器207,用于显示通信系统的信息,显示图形用户界面(graphical user interface,GUI),显示由用户输入的信息或提供给用户的信息以及手机的各种菜单,还可以接受用户输入。
以下将通过具体实施例对本申请实施例提供的显示控制方法进行详细阐述。
本申请实施例提供了一种显示控制方法,参见图3,该方法可以包括:
301、第一设备获取映射信息,映射信息包括多个对应关系,多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态inactive或连接态。
该场景信息可以包括:第一工作场景,第一设备所在的小区为第一通信系统的小区且支持与第二通信系统的联合组网(也称支持非独立(non-standalone,NSA)组网);或者,第二工作场景,第一设备通过第一通信系统的空口注册在第二通信系统的核心网;或者,第三工作场景,第一设备所在的小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,第四工作场景,第一设备连接在第一通信系统的基站,且第一设备具有第二通信系统的辅基站。其中,第三工作场景可以包括:第一设备处于连接态时的服务小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,第一设备处于空闲态或非激活态时的驻留小区为第二通信系统的小区。
示例性的,第二通信系统可以为5G系统,第一通信系统可以为4G系统。上述第一工作场景可以包括:第一设备所在的小区为4G的LTE小区且支持与5G的新空口(new radio,NR)小区的联合组网。上述第二工作场景可以包括:第一设备工作在eLTE基站下,通过4G系统的空口注册在5G系统的核心网。上述第三工作场景可以包括:第一设备连接在NR小区,或者第一设备驻留在NR小区。上述第四工作场景可以包括:第一设备连接在4G的LTE基站,且第一设备具有5G系统的辅基站。
其中,映射信息中的多个对应关系具体可以是一种第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,也可以是多种第一参数信息的组合与多个网络图标的对应关系。并且,每种第一参数信息具体可以包括一个参数可以包括多个参数。
示例性的,该映射信息所表示的第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系可以参见如下表1。在表1中,每一行表示一种对应关系。在每一行表示的对应关系中,网络图标与标有“√”标识的第一参数信息相关。
如表1所示,映射信息中可以包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,或位置信息中的任意一种与网络图标的对应关系。例如,映射信息包括指示信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括频率信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括服务类型与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括运营商信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括位置信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括连接状态信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括场景信息与网络图标的对应关系。
如表1所示,映射信息中还可以包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,或位置信息中的任意多种的组合与多个网络图标的对应关系。例如,映射信息包括指示信息和频率信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括频率信息和连接状态信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括指示信息、运营商信息和位置信息与网络图标的对应关系。再例如,映射信息包括频率信息、服务类型和运营商信息与网络图标的对应关系等。
表1
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000001
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000002
需要说明的是,映射信息中还可以包括表1所举示例以外的其他对应关系,本申请实施例不予一一列举。
302、第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据第一设备的工作状态获取m个第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n的正整数。
其中,第一设备所在小区的服务频率,第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率,第一设备当前所使用的服务,第一设备当前所使用的运营商,第一设备当前所在的位置,第一设备当前所处的连接状态,或第一设备当前所处的工作场景等等。
具体的,第一设备可以从第二设备获取m个第一参数信息;或者,第一设备可以根据第一设备的工作状态从第一设备自身获取m个第一参数信息;或者,第一设备可以从第二设备获取m个第一参数信息中的一部分参数信息,并根据第一设备的工作状态从第一设备自身获取m个第一参数信息中的另一部分参数信息。
303、第一设备根据m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。
第一设备在上述步骤302中获取m个第一参数信息之后,可以在上述映射关系中查找与步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息对应的网络图标,并显示查找到的该网络图标。若第一设备获取到的m个第一参数信息不同,则第一设备查找到的网络图标也可能不同,那么第一设备显示的网络图标也可能不同。
其中,第一设备显示网络图标是指,第一设备在状态栏息屏显示(always on display,AOD)时显示网络图标等。示例性的,如图4中的(a)和(b)所示,第一设备显示的网络图标可以是状态栏401中显示“5G”图标402或“5G+”图标403等。
可见,在本申请实施例提供的显示控制方法中,第一设备可以根据从第二设备获取到的或根据第一设备的工作状态获取到的不同的第一参数信息,动态地显示不同的网络图标,而并不像现有技术那样仅能保持显示第一设备所注册的网络的图标,因而能够灵活地对网络图标的显示进行控制,更为方便地满足运营商的运维需求。
其中,第一参数信息中的指示信息可以是第一设备从第二设备接收到的信息。例如,该指示信息可以为第一设备从第二设备接收到的广播信息。示例性的,广播信息具体可以为系统信息,第二设备可以是基站,基站可以通过系统信息将指示信息发送给第一设备。第一设备可以根据基站发送的不同指示信息,灵活显示不同的网络图标。
另外,由于不同运营商可能支持的网络图标的显示配置不同,因而第一参数信息中还可以包括运营商信息。第一参数信息中的运营商信息用于表示第一设备所使用的运营商,例如运营商信息可以包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识、运营商的名称(例如移动、联通、电信等)或运营商的机构代码等。
由于运营商在不同地域所支持的网络图标的显示配置也可能不同,因而第一参数信息中还可以包括位置信息。第一参数信息中的位置信息用于表示第一设备所处的位置,例如位置信息可以包括第一设备所在位置的国家代码,省市代码,全球定位系统GPS信息,或第一设备所在地理位置的名称中的至少一种。其中,省市代码是指各地区(例如各省或各市)的地理代码,例如可以是电话区号。
第一参数信息中的服务类型用于表示第一设备当前所使用的服务的类型,例如可以包括载波聚合CA服务、双连接DC服务或多输入多出MIMO服务等中的一种或多种。第一设备可以根据当前所使用 的不同服务,灵活显示不同的网络图标。
此外,第一设备的当前所处的连接状态不同或第一设备当前所处的工作场景不同,第一设备显示的网络图标也可以不同。因而,第一参数信息可以根据不同的连接状态和工作场景对应的状态信息和场景信息,灵活显示不同的网络图标。
在上述步骤301中,映射信息具体可以是第一设备从其他设备获取的信息。例如,第一设备可以从第三设备获取该映射信息,第三设备可以是与第二设备相同的基站。再例如,第一设备可以从与第二设备不同的第三设备获取该映射信息,第二设备可以是基站,第三设备可以是云服务器等网络设备。其中,与第一设备从基站获取映射信息相比,第一设备从云服务器等其他设备获取映射信息可以节省基站空口信令的开销。
或者,在上述步骤301中,映射信息具体还可以是预制在第一设备上的信息,第一设备可以从本设备获取该预制的信息。例如,该映射信息可以预制在用户身份识别模块SIM卡中,该SIM卡可以是实体卡也可以是虚拟卡,第一设备可以从SIM卡中获取预制的映射信息。再例如,该映射信息可以预制在第一设备的存储器中,第一设备可以从存储器中获取预制的映射信息。
此外,映射信息还可以预制在外部存储设备(例如SD卡或移动硬盘等)中,当第一设备插入该外部存储设备或与该外部存储设备建立连接时,第一设备可以从该外部存储设备获取预制的映射信息。
本申请以下实施例将通过举例的方式对表1所示的映射关系进行具体阐述。
(1)、映射信息包括指示信息与网络图标的对应关系,即映射信息用于表示指示信息的含义。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括指示信息。
例如,映射信息中的指示信息包括1bit(比特)信息,用于对应两种不同的网络图标。示例性的,参见如表2,指示信息“0”对应“5G”图标,指示信息“1”对应“5G+”图标。
表2
指示信息 网络图标
0 5G
1 5G+
举例来说,若第一设备在步骤302中从基站接收到的1bit指示信息为“1”,则第一设备根据表2所示的映射信息可以确定指示信息“1”对应的网络图标为“5G+”图标,因而第一设备可以在第一设备的状态栏显示“5G+”图标。
再例如,映射信息中的指示信息包括2bit信息,用于对应3种不同的网络图标。示例性的,参见如表3,指示信息“00”对应“4G”图标,指示信息“01”对应“5G”图标,指示信息“10”对应“5G+”图标。
表3
指示信息 网络图标
00 4G
01 5G
10 5G+
举例来说,若第一设备在步骤302中从基站接收到的2bit指示信息为“01”,则第一设备根据表3所示的映射信息可以确定指示信息“01”对应的网络图标为“5G”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G”图标。若第一设备在步骤302中从基站接收到的2bit指示信息为“10”,则第一设备根据表3所示的映射信息可以确定指示信息“10”对应的网络图标为“5G+”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G+”图标。
(2)、映射信息包括指示信息和运营商信息与网络图标的对应关系,不同运营商对应的指示信息的含义不同。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括指示信息和运营商信息。
例如,运营商信息为PLMN标识,指示信息为2bit信息,运营商信息和指示信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表4。
表4
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000003
需要注意的是,表4中的“—”表示“空值”,即没有对应的网络图标。
举例来说,若在步骤302中,第一设备从基站接收到的2bit指示信息为“01”,第一设备当前所使用的运营商为运营商1,第一设备根据当前使用的运营商1获取到的运营商信息为PLMN1,则第一设备根据表4所示的映射信息可以确定运营商1和指示信息“01”对应的网络图标为“5G”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G”图标。若第一设备在步骤302中从基站接收到的2bit指示信息为“11”,第一设备使用的运营商为运营商2,第一设备根据当前使用的运营商2获取到的运营商信息为PLMN2,则第一设备根据表4所示的映射信息可以确定运营商2和指示信息“11”对应的网络图标为“5G+”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G+”图标。
可见,第一设备可以根据第二设备发送的不同指示信息,灵活显示不同的网络图标。
(3)、映射信息包括指示信息和位置信息与网络图标的对应关系,不同地域对应的指示信息的含义不同。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括指示信息和位置信息。
例如,位置信息为国家名称英文缩写,US表示美国,CHINA表示中国,指示信息为2bit信息,位置信息和指示信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表5。
表5
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000004
举例来说,若在步骤302中,第一设备从基站接收到的2bit指示信息为“01”,第一设备当前所在位置为美国,第一设备根据当前所在位置获取到的位置信息为US,则第一设备根据表5所示的映射信息可以确定US和指示信息“01”对应的网络图标为“LTE-A”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“LTE-A”图标。若第一设备在步骤302中从基站接收到的2bit指示信息为“11”,第一设备所在的位置为中国,第一设备根据当前所在位置获取到的位置信息为CHINA,则第一设备根据表5所示的映射信息可以确定 CHINA和指示信息“11”对应的网络图标为“5G+”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G+”图标。
(4)、映射信息包括指示信息、运营商信息和位置信息与网络图标的对应关系,不同运营商、不同地域对应的指示信息的含义不同。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、运营商信息和位置信息。例如,指示信息、运营商信息和位置信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表6。
表6
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000005
举例来说,若在步骤302中,第一设备从基站接收到的2bit指示信息为“01”;第一设备当前所在的位置为美国,第一设备根据当前所在位置获取到的位置信息为US;第一设备当前所使用的运营商为运营商2,第一设备根据当前所使用的运营商获取到的运营商信息为PLMN2;则第一设备根据表6所示的映射信息可以确定US、PLMN2和指示信息“01”对应的网络图标为“5G”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G”图标。
(5)、映射信息包括指示信息和频率信息与网络图标的对应关系。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括指示信息和频率信息。其中,该指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标,该频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号。其中,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值(例如6GHz)。
基于此,参见图5,上述步骤302具体可以包括:
501、第一设备从第二设备接收指示信息。
502、第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取频率信息。
上述步骤303具体可以包括:
503、若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标。
504、若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
例如,第二通信系统为5G系统(或称为NR系统);指示信息为1bit信息,“0”表示不显示5G系统的网络图标,“1”表示显示5G系统的网络图标;第一参数信息中的频率信息包括“服务频率为低频 信号”和“服务频率为高频信号”;或者,频率信息包括“<6GHz(赫兹)”和“≥6GHz”。频率信息和指示信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表7。
表7
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000006
举例来说,若在步骤302中,第一设备从基站接收到的2bit指示信息为“1”;第一设备当前所在小区的服务频率为6.5GHz,第一设备根据当前所在小区的服务频率获取到的第一参数信息中的频率信息为“服务频率为高频信号”,则第一设备根据表7确定指示信息“1”和频率信息“服务频率为高频信号”对应的网络图标为“5G+”图标,因而第一设备显示“5G+”图标。
(6)、映射信息包括频率信息与网络图标的对应关系,第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括频率信息和场景信息。其中,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值(例如6GHz)。
基于此,上述步骤302具体可以包括:
601、第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取频率信息。
602、第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。
上述步骤303具体可以包括:
603、若场景信息为第三工作场景或第四工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标。
604、若场景信息为第三工作场景或第四工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
其中,当第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统时,第三工作场景可以包括:第一设备连接在NR小区,或者第一设备驻留在NR小区;第四工作场景可以包括:第一设备连接在4G的LTE基站,且第一设备具有5G系统的辅基站。
例如,第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统;第一参数信息中的频率信息包括“服务频率为低频信号”和“服务频率为高频信号”;或者,频率信息包括“<6GHz”和“≥6GHz”。在第一工作场景或第二工作场景下,频率信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表8。
表8
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000007
举例来说,若第一设备连接在4G系统的LTE基站下,且具有5G系统NR辅基站,则第一设备在步 骤302中获取到的m个第一参数信息中的场景信息为第四工作场景;若第一设备当前所在小区的服务频率为4.7GHz,第一设备在步骤302中根据当前所在小区的服务频率获取到的m个第一参数信息中的频率信息为“服务频率为低频信号”,则第一设备可以根据表8确定场景信息为“第四工作场景”以及频率信息为“服务频率为低频信号”对应的网络图标为“5G”图标,因而可以显示“5G”图标。
在一种情况下,当第一设备通过第一通信系统的空口注册在第二通信系统的核心网,且第一设备具有第二通信系统的辅基站时,例如,第一设备工作在eLTE基站下,通过4G系统的空口注册在5G系统的核心网,且有5G系统的辅基站时,第一设备当前也处于第四场景,可以采用(6)中的方案显示网络图标。
(7)、映射信息包括频率信息和场景信息与网络图标的对应关系。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括频率信息和场景信息。其中,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖。这里的同运营商的相邻小区是指与第一设备所在的小区对应相同的运营商的相邻小区。其中,低频信号的频率小于预设值(例如6GHz),高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
基于此,上述步骤302具体可以包括:
701、第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息。
702、第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。
上述步骤303具体可以包括:
703、若场景信息为第三工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,且第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第一网络图标。
704、若场景信息为第三工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,且第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二网络图标。
其中,当第二通信系统为5G系统时,第三工作场景可以包括:第一设备连接在NR小区,或者第一设备驻留在NR小区。
例如,第一参数信息中的频率信息可以包括“服务频率为低频信号,无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”和“服务频率为低频信号,有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”。
示例性的,当第二通信系统为5G系统时,在第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号的基础上,若第一设备有5G系统NR小区的高频信号覆盖,则该NR小区不是第一设备所在的小区,而是第一设备所在小区的相邻小区,因而若第一设备有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖,则可以表明第一设备有同运营商的相邻NR小区的高频信号覆盖。因而,频率信息具体可以包括“服务频率为低频信号,无同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”和“服务频率为低频信号,有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”。场景信息和频率信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表9。
表9
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000008
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000009
举例来说,若第二通信系统为5G系统,第一设备当前所在的小区为5G系统的NR小区,则第一设备在步骤302中获取到的场景信息为第三工作场景。若第一设备所在NR小区的服务频率小于预设值(例如6GHz),则服务频率为低频信号,第一设备所在NR小区为低频小区。若第一设备所在小区的相邻NR小区的信号的频率包括大于预设值(例如6GHz)的高频信号,该NR小区也为5G系统,且与第一设备所在的小区对应相同的运营商,则第一设备可以确定步骤302中获取到的频率信息为“服务频率为低频信号,有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”。第一设备根据表9所示的映射关系可以确定步骤302中获取到的m个第一参数信息对应的图标为“5G+”图标,从而可以在状态栏显示“5G+”图标。
具体的,当第一设备所在小区为5G系统的NR低频小区,且第一设备有相同运营商的NR高频小区覆盖时,可以说明第一设备所在的小区具有添加NR高频小区作为辅小区的可能性,因而第一设备可以显示不同于“5G”图标的其他图标,例如可以显示“5G+”图标。
再例如,第二通信系统为5G系统,第一参数信息中的频率信息包括服务频率为低频信号,以及至少一个与第一设备对应相同运营商的相邻NR小区的高频信号的频率值,比如“6.5GHz,7.2GHz和8.4GHz”。示例性的,场景信息和频率信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表10。
表10
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000010
若第二通信系统为5G系统,第一设备当前所在的小区为5G系统的NR小区,则第一设备在步骤302中获取到的场景信息为第三工作场景;若第一设备根据所在NR小区的服务频率小于预设值(例如6GHz),第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号;且第一设备所在小区的相邻NR小区的信号的频率包括6.5GHz,则第一设备在步骤302中获取到的频率信息为“服务频率为低频信号,相邻NR小区的服务频率包括6.5GHz、7.2GHz或8.4GHz”。第一设备根据表10所示的映射关系确定步骤302中的m个第一参数信息对应的图标为“5G+”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G+”图标。其中,由于6.5GHz是与第一设备对应相同运营商的相邻NR小区的高频信号的频率值,因而,当第一设备所在小区的相邻NR小区的信号的频率包括6.5GHz,可以表明第一设备有同运营商的相邻NR小区的高频信号覆盖。
若第二通信系统为5G系统,第一设备当前所在的小区为5G系统的NR小区,则第一设备获取到的场景信息为第三工作场景;若第一设备所在小区的相邻NR小区的信号的频率不包括6.5GHz、7.2GHz和8.4GHz,第一设备无同运营商的相邻NR小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备可以根据表10所示的映射关系显示“5G”图标。
再例如,第二通信系统为5G系统,第一参数信息中的频率信息包括服务频率为低频信号以及同运营商的相邻NR小区的高频信号的范围。其中,在第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号的基础上,若第一设备有高频信号的覆盖,则该高频信号是相邻小区的高频信号。示例性的,频率信息具体可以包括“服务频率为低频信号,同运营商的NR小区的服务频率<6GHz”和“服务频率为低频信号,同运营 商的NR小区的服务频率≥6GHz”。示例性的,场景信息和频率信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表11。
表11
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000011
(8)、映射信息包括频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息与网络图标的对应关系。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息。其中,频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
基于此,参见图6,上述步骤302具体可以包括:
801、第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息。
802、第一设备根据当前所处的连接状态获取连接状态信息。
803、第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。
上述步骤303具体可以包括:
804、若场景信息为第三工作场景,连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第三网络图标。
805、若场景信息为第三工作场景,连接状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第四网络图标。
806、若场景信息为第三工作场景,连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第五网络图标。
807、若场景信息为第三工作场景,连接状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第六网络图标。
其中,第三网络图标、第四网络图标、第五网络图标和第六网络图标可以相同或不同。当第二通信系统为5G系统时,第三工作场景可以包括:第一设备连接在NR小区,或者第一设备驻留在NR小区。
例如,第一参数信息中的频率信息可以包括“服务频率为低频信号,无同第二通信系统运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”和“服务频率为低频信号,有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”。
示例性的,若第二通信系统为5G系统,在第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号的基础上,若第一设备有5G系统NR小区的高频信号覆盖,则该NR小区不是第一设备所在的小区,而是第一设备所在小区的相邻小区,因而若第一设备有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖,则可以表明第一设备有同运营商的相邻NR小区的高频信号覆盖。因而,频率信息具体可以包括“服务频率为低频信号,无同运 营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”和“服务频率为低频信号,有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”。场景信息、连接状态信息和频率信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表12。
表12
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000012
其中,当第二通信系统为5G系统时,第一设备处于“第三工作场景,空闲态(或非激活态)”表示第一设备驻留在NR小区;第一设备处于“第三工作场景,连接态)”表示第一设备连接在NR小区。
举例来说,若第二通信系统为5G系统,第一设备当前驻留在5G系统的NR小区,则第一设备在步骤320中获取到的场景信息为第三工作场景,获取到的连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态。若第一设备当前所在NR小区的服务频率小于预设值(例如6GHz),则服务频率为低频信号,第一设备所在NR小区为低频小区。若第一设备所在小区的相邻NR小区的信号的频率包括大于预设值(例如6GHz)的高频信号,该相邻NR小区与第一设备所在的小区对应相同的运营商,则第一设备有同运营商的相邻NR小区的覆盖。因此,第一设备在步骤302中获取到的频率信息可以为“服务频率为低频信号,有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”。当采用表12中的配置1时,第一设备可以该配置1所对应的映射关系确定该m个第一参数信息对应的图标为“5G+”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G+”图标。
(9)、映射信息包括频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息与网络图标的对应关系。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、频率信息和场景信息。其中,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
基于此,上述步骤302具体可以包括:
901、第一设备从第二设备接收指示信息。
902、第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取频率信息。
903、第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。
上述步骤303具体可以包括:
904、若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景, 频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第一网络图标。
905、若指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
其中,当第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统时,第一工作场景可以包括:第一设备所在的小区为4G的LTE小区且支持与5G的NR小区的联合组网;第二工作场景可以包括:第一设备工作在eLTE基站下,通过4G系统的空口注册在5G系统的核心网。
例如,第二通信系统为5G系统,第一参数信息中的指示信息可以为1bit信息,其中指示信息“1”表示显示5G系统的网络图标;指示信息“0”表示不显示5G系统的网络图标。第一参数信息中的频率信息包括“服务频率为低频信号,无同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”和“服务频率为低频信号,有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”。示例性的,场景信息和频率信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表13。
表13
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000013
举例来说,若第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统,第一设备所在的小区为4G的LTE小区且支持与5G的NR小区的联合组网,则第一设备在步骤302中获取到的场景信息为第一工作场景。若第一设备根据所在LTE小区的服务频率小于预设值(例如6GHz),则服务频率为低频信号,第一设备所在LTE小区为低频小区。若第一设备所在小区的相邻NR小区的信号的频率包括大于预设值(例如6GHz)的高频信号,该相邻小区与第一设备所在的小区对应相同的运营商,则第一设备在步骤302中获取到的频率信息可以为“服务频率为低频信号,有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”。第一设备根据表13所示的映射关系确定步骤302中的m个第一参数信息对应的图标为“5G+”图标,因而可以显示“5G+”图标。
具体的,当第一设备所在的小区为4G的LTE小区且支持与5G的NR小区的联合组网,且第一设备有相同运营商的NR高频小区覆盖时,可以说明第一设备所在的小区具有添加NR高频小区作为辅小区的可能性,因而第一设备可以显示不同于“5G”图标的其他图标,例如“5G+”图标。
(10)、映射信息包括频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息与网络图标的对应关系。第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括指示信息、频率信息、连接状态信息和场景信息。其中,指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,低频信号的频率小于预设值,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
基于此,参见图7,上述步骤302具体可以包括:
1001、第一设备从第二设备接收指示信息。
1002、第一设备根据第一设备所在小区的服务频率和第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获 取频率信息。
1003、第一设备根据当前所处的连接状态获取连接状态信息。
1004、第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。
上述步骤303具体可以包括:
1005、若场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第七网络图标。
1006、若场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第八网络图标。
1007、若场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第九网络图标。
1008、若场景信息为第一工作场景或第二工作场景,指示信息指示显示第二通信系统的网络图标,状态信息为连接态,且频率信息表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,第一设备无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则第一设备显示第二通信系统的第十网络图标。
其中,第七网络图标、第八网络图标、第九网络图标和第十网络图标可以相同或不同。当第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统时,第一工作场景可以包括:第一设备所在的小区为4G的LTE小区且支持与5G的NR小区的联合组网;第二工作场景可以包括:第一设备工作在eLTE基站下,通过4G系统的空口注册在5G系统的核心网。
例如,第一参数信息中的频率信息包括“服务频率为低频信号,无第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”和“服务频率为低频信号,有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”。示例性的,若第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统,则频率信息具体可以包括“服务频率为低频信号,无同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”和“服务频率为低频信号,有同运营商的NR小区的高频信号覆盖”。第一参数信息中的指示信息可以为1bit信息,其中指示信息“1”表示显示5G系统的网络图标;指示信息“0”表示不显示5G系统的网络图标。场景信息、连接状态信息和频率信息与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见如下表14。
表14
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000014
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000015
示例性的,当第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统时,第一设备处于“第一工作场景,空闲态(或非激活态)”可以包括第一设备驻留在支持NSA的4G系统LTE小区;第一设备处于“第一工作场景,连接态)”可以包括第一设备连接在在支持NSA的4G系统LTE小区。
示例性的,当第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统时,第一设备处于“第二工作场景,空闲态(或非激活态)”可以包括第一设备驻留在eLTE小区,且注册在5G核心网;第一设备处于“第二工作场景,连接态)”可以包括第一设备连接在eLTE小区,且注册在5G核心网。
举例来说,若在步骤302中,第一设备从基站(即第二设备)接收到的指示信息为“1”,则表明第一设备需要显示5G图标。若第一设备当前驻留在支持NSA的4G系统LTE小区,则第一设备在步骤302中获取到的场景信息为第一工作场景,获取到的连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态。若第一设备所在小区的服务频率小于预设值(例如6GHz),则服务频率为低频信号,第一设备所在小区为低频小区。若第一设备所在小区的相邻NR小区的信号的频率包括大于预设值(例如6GHz)的高频信号,该相邻小区与第一设备所在的小区对应相同的运营商,则第一设备在步骤302中获取到的频率信息可以为“服务频率为低频信号,有同系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”。此时,当采用表14中的配置1时,第一设备可以该配置1所对应的映射关系确定步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息对应的图标为“5G+”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G+”图标。
具体的,当第一设备在第一工作场景下驻留在支持NSA的4G系统LTE小区,且第一设备有相同运营商的NR高频小区覆盖时,可以说明第一设备所在的小区具有添加NR高频小区作为辅小区的可能性,因而第一设备可以显示不同于“5G”图标的其他图标,例如“5G+”图标。
(11)、映射信息包括服务类型和场景信息与网络图标的对应关系,第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括服务类型和场景信息。
基于此,上述步骤302具体可以包括:
1101、第一设备根据第一设备当前所使用的服务获取服务类型。
1102、第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。
上述步骤303具体可以包括:
1103、若场景信息为第三工作场景,服务类型为载波聚合CA服务,则第一设备显示第十一网络图标。
1104、若场景信息为第三工作场景,服务类型为双连接DC服务,则第一设备显示第十二网络图标。
1105、若场景信息为第三工作场景,服务类型为多入多出MIMO服务,则第一设备显示第十三网络图标。
1106、否则,第一设备显示第十四网络图标。
其中,当第二通信系统为5G系统时,第三工作场景可以包括:第一设备连接在NR小区,或者第一设备驻留在NR小区。
由上述步骤1103-步骤1106可知,第一设备可以根据当前使用的不同服务显示不同的网络图标。
例如,第二通信系统为5G系统,服务类型与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见表15。
表15
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000016
举例来说,若第二通信系统为5G系统,第一设备当前所在的小区为5G系统的NR小区,则第一设备在步骤302中获取到的场景信息为第三工作场景。若第一设备根据当前所使用的服务确定服务类型包括CA,则第一设备根据表15可知,第三工作场景和CA对应的网络图标为“5G-CA”图标,因而第一设备可以显示“5G-CA”图标。若第一设备处于第三工作场景,且第一设备根据当前所使用的服务确定服务类型不包括CA、DC和MINO,则第一设备可以显示5G图标。
上述表15是以映射信息中的第一参数信息仅包括服务类型为例进行说明的,映射信息中的第一参数信息还可以包括服务类型与指示信息、频率信息、运营商信息或位置信息的组合。例如,映射信息包括指示信息和服务类型与网络图标之间的对应关系。指示信息为1bit信息,指示信息“1”表示显示第二通信系统的图标,指示信息“0”表示显示第一通信系统的图标。
示例性的,第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统,指示信息和服务类型与网络图标之间的对应关系可以参见表16或表17。
表16
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000017
表17
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000018
(12)、映射信息包括场景信息与网络图标的对应关系,第一设备在步骤302中获取的m个第一参数信息包括场景信息。基于此,上述步骤302可以包括:第一设备根据第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取场景信息。上述步骤303可以包括:当场景信息为第二工作场景时,第一设备显示第二通信系统的网络图标。也就是说,当第一设备通过第一通信系统的空口注册在第二通信系统的核心网时,第一设备可以显示第二通信系统的网络图标。示例性的,当第二通信系统为5G系统,第一通信系统为4G系统时,若第一设备通过4G的空口注册在5G的核心网,则第一设备可以显示5G系统的网络图标。
另外,还需要说明的是,以上所举示例仅是对本申请实施例中映射信息中的第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系的举例说明,并不作为具体限定。本申请实施例提供的显示控制方法涉及的映射信息中的第一参数信息与网络图标还可以有其他的对应关系,映射信息中的第一参数信息还可以是指示信息、频率信息、服务类型、运营商信息和位置信息中的其他组合,此处不予一一列举。
本申请其他一些实施例还提供了一种测量方法,参见图8,该方法可以包括:
1201、第一设备获取检测信息,检测信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种。
1202、第一设备根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
在该测量方法中,第一设备可以根据获取的检测信息中第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息,直接测量相邻小区的信号,而不需要通过盲搜先搜索到相邻小区的频率等测量信息后再进行信号测量,因而可以节省第一设备在全频搜索的时间和功耗,延长第一设备的工作时长。并且,第一设备可以根据获取的检测信息中的时间信息,间歇性地测量相邻小区的信号,而不用实时地、持续地进行测量,因而可以进一步降低第一设备的功耗。
其中,第二参数信息具体可以包括目标通信系统中相邻小区的测量信息和时间信息;和/或,目标通信系统中相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息和时间信息。
在一种方案中,第一设备获取检测信息可以包括:第一设备获取第一设备上预制的检测信息。具体的,与映射信息类似,检测信息可以预制在第一设备的SIM卡或存储器等位置。这样,检测信息时预制在第一设备上的,第一设备可以根据预制的测量信息和时间信息,方便、直接、间歇性地测量相邻小区的信号,以降低第一设备的功耗。
在另一种方案中,第一设备获取检测信息可以包括:第一设备从第三设备获取检测信息。其中,第三设备可以是与第二设备相同的设备,例如第三设备可以是基站;或者,第三设备也可以是与第二设备不同的设备,例如第三设备可以是云服务器。与第一设备从基站获取检测信息相比,第一设备从云服务器等设备获取检测信息可以节省基站空口信令的开销。
本申请实施例提供的测量方法还可以应用于上述实施例所描述的显示控制方法的过程中。具体的,在上述第(7)-(10)所描述的方案中,附图虽未示出,但在步骤701、步骤801、步骤902或步骤1002中获取频率信息之前,该方法还可以包括:
1301、第一设备获取检测信息,检测信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种。
1302、第一设备根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
这样,第一设备在进行网络图标的显示控制时,可以根据获取的检测信息中第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息,直接测量相邻小区的信号,而不需要通过盲搜先搜索到相邻小区的频率等测量信息后再进行信号测量,因而可以节省第一设备在全频搜索的时间和功耗,延长第一设备的工作时长。并且,第一设备可以根据获取的检测信息中的时间信息,间歇性地测量相邻小区的信号,而不用实时地、持续 地进行测量,因而可以进一步降低第一设备的功耗。
在上述第(7)-(10)所描述的方案中,步骤302中的m个第一参数信息中的频率信息用于表示第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及第一设备是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖。在测量获的相邻小区的信号之后,在步骤701、步骤801、步骤902或步骤1002中,第一设备通过检测信息测量相邻小区的信号,可以确定是否有相邻小区的信号覆盖,以确定是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖。若第一设备确定有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,且第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,则第一设备获取到的m个第一参数信息中的频率信息为“服务频率为低频信号,有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”,第一设备可以显示该频率信息对应的图标。
应用于上述第(7)-(10)所描述的方案,上述目标通信系统可以为第二通信系统,第二参数信息具体可以包括第二通信系统中相邻小区的测量信息和时间信息;和/或,第二通信系统中相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息和时间信息。
当第二参数信息包括第二通信系统中相邻小区的测量信息和时间信息时,示例性的,若第二通信系统为5G系统,则第二参数信息可以包括第一设备所在小区的NR相邻小区的测量信息和时间信息。
当第二参数信息包括第二通信系统中相邻小区高频信号的测量信息和时间信息时,第一设备可以根据检测信息直接测量第二通信系统中相邻小区高频信号,以确定是否有第二通信系统中相邻小区高频信号的覆盖,从而方便第一设备根据是否有第二通信系统中相邻小区高频信号的覆盖,获取上述(7)-(10)的方案中m个第一参数信息中的频率信息。
上述检测信息中的第二参数信息包括的相邻小区的测量信息和时间信息,具体还可以是第二通信系统中与第一设备所在小区对应相同运营商的相邻小区的测量信息和时间信息;或者,具体可以是第二通信系统中与第一设备所在小区对应相同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息和时间信息。这样,可以方便第一设备根据检测信息确定是否有第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号的覆盖,从而获取上述(7)-(10)的方案中m个第一参数信息中的频率信息。
在本申请其他一些实施例中,检测信息还可以包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。也就是说,相邻小区的信号的测量信息和时间信息与运营信息和/或位置信息有关,运营信息和/或位置信息不同则相邻小区的信号的测量信息和时间信息也可能不同。其中,运营商信息可以是PLMN标识等信息。位置信息可以是国家代码、省市代码或GPS定位信息等。测量信息可以包括小区的服务频率、小区的频段或小区信息。时间信息可以是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,或者,时间信息可以应用于定时器(timer)。
举例来说,第一设备可以根据检测信息获取到不同运营商小区的服务频率,或者获取到不同运营小区的定时器,或者获取到不同运营商小区在不同地域位置的服务频率,或者获取到不同运营商小区在不同地域位置的定时器等,从而根据获取到的信息进行信号测量。
其中,参见图9中的(a)、(b)和(c),周期信息可以为第一设备进行相邻两次测量(即测量相邻小区的信号)时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
当时间信息应用于定时器时,时间信息可以用于以下至少一项:时间信息用于第一设备在定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在获取到检测信息后,开启定时器;或者,时间信息用于第一设备在获取到进行信息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启定时器。
举例来说,检测信息包括第三参数信息与第二参数信息的对应关系,第三参数信息包括位置信息和运营商信息;第二通信系统为5G系统,第二参数信息包括相邻NR小区的服务频率、频段和定时器,以及相邻NR小区的高频信号的服务频率、频段和定时器,检测信息可以如表17所示。其中,位置信息“US”表示美国,位置信息“CHINA”表示中国。
表18
Figure PCTCN2019100907-appb-000019
示例性的,在上述(8)中提供的配置1的方案中,若第二通信系统为5G系统,第一设备驻留在NR低频(如<6GHz)小区,第一设备的运营信息为PLMN1,第一设备的位置信息为CHINA,则第一设备可以在表18中查找PLMN1、CHINA对应的NR高频信号的服务频率、频段和定时器,具体如表18中下划线标识部分所示。此时,第一设备可以根据服务频率f1,f2;或根据频段band1,band2在上述(8)中直接测量相邻NR小区的高频信号,从而节省全频盲检所花费的时间和功耗;并且,第一设备可以根据定时器3在上述(8)中直接测量相邻NR小区的高频信号,从而避免实时测量导致的高功耗。当第一设备根据服务频率f1,f2或频段band1,band2以及定时器3进行测量从而确定被第二通信系统同运营的相邻小区的高频信号(如≥6GHz)覆盖时,第一设备在步骤302中获取到的m个第一参数信息中的频率信息为“服务频率为低频信号,有同系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖”,第一设备可以显示配置1中该频率信息对应的“5G+”图标。
可以理解的是,第一设备为了实现上述功能,其包含了执行各个功能相应的硬件和/或软件模块。结合本文中所公开的实施例描述的各示例的算法步骤,本申请能够以硬件或硬件和计算机软件的结合形式来实现。某个功能究竟以硬件还是计算机软件驱动硬件的方式来执行,取决于技术方案的特定应用和设计约束条件。本领域技术人员可以结合实施例对每个特定的应用来使用不同方法来实现所描述的功能,但是这种实现不应认为超出本申请的范围。
本申请实施例可以根据上述方法示例对第一设备进行功能模块的划分,例如,可以对应各个功能划 分各个功能模块,也可以将两个或两个以上的功能集成在一个处理模块中。上述集成的模块可以采用硬件的形式实现。需要说明的是,本申请实施例中对模块的划分是示意性的,仅仅为一种逻辑功能划分,实际实现时可以有另外的划分方式。
在采用对应各个功能划分各个功能模块的情况下,图10示出了上述实施例中涉及的第一设备1400的一种可能的组成示意图,如图10所示,该第一设备1400可以包括:第一获取单元1401、第二获取单元1402、第三获取单元1403、显示单元1404和测量单元1405。并且,第一获取单元1401、第二获取单元1402和第三获取单元1403可以是分别独立的三个模块,也可以是一个整体的获取模块,本申请实施例不予具体限定。
其中,第一获取单元1401可以用于支持第一设备1400执行上述步骤301等,和/或用于本文所描述的技术的其他过程。
第二获取单元1402可以用于支持第一设备1400执行上述步骤501-501、步骤601-602、步骤701-702、步骤801-803、步骤901-903、步骤1401-1404、步骤1101-1102等,和/或用于本文所描述的技术的其他过程。
显示单元1404可以用于支持第一设备1400执行上述步骤503-504、步骤603-604、步骤703-704、步骤804-807、步骤904-905、步骤1405-1408、步骤1103-1106等,和/或用于本文所描述的技术的其他过程。
第三获取单元1403可以用于支持第一设备1400执行上述步骤1301,和/或用于本文所描述的技术的其他过程。
测量单元1405可以用于支持第一设备1400执行上述步骤1302,和/或用于本文所描述的技术的其他过程。
需要说明的是,上述方法实施例涉及的各步骤的所有相关内容均可以援引到对应功能模块的功能描述,在此不再赘述。
本申请实施例提供的第一设备,用于执行上述在预览界面中显示业务信息的实现方法,因此可以达到与上述实现方法相同的效果。
在采用集成的单元的情况下,第一设备可以包括处理模块和存储模块。其中,处理模块可以用于对第一设备的动作进行控制管理,例如,可以用于支持第一设备执行上述第一获取单元1401、第二获取单元1402、第三获取单元1403、显示单元1404和测量单元1405执行的步骤。存储模块可以用于支持第一设备存储映射信息、检测信息以及存储程序代码和数据等。另外,第一设备还可以包括通信模块,可以用于支持第一设备与其他设备的通信。例如,处理模块可以控制通信模块从其他设备获取映射信息或检测信息等。
其中,处理模块可以是处理器或控制器。其可以实现或执行结合本申请公开内容所描述的各种示例性的逻辑方框,模块和电路。处理器也可以是实现计算功能的组合,例如包含一个或多个微处理器组合,数字信号处理(digital signal processing,DSP)和微处理器的组合等等。存储模块可以是存储器。通信模块具体可以为射频电路、蓝牙芯片、wifi芯片等与其他第一设备交互的设备。
在一个实施例中,当处理模块为处理器,存储模块为存储器时,本申请实施例所涉及的第一设备可以为具有图2所示结构的设备。
本申请实施例还提供一种计算机存储介质,该计算机存储介质中存储有计算机指令,当该计算机指令在第一设备上运行时,使得第一设备执行上述相关方法步骤实现上述实施例中的显示控制方法。
本申请实施例还提供了一种计算机程序产品,当该计算机程序产品在计算机上运行时,使得计算机执行上述相关步骤,以实现上述实施例中的在预览界面中的显示控制方法。
另外,本申请的实施例还提供一种装置,这个装置具体可以是芯片,组件或模块,该装置可包括相连的处理器和存储器;其中,存储器用于存储计算机执行指令,当装置运行时,处理器可执行存储器存储的计算机执行指令,以使芯片执行上述各方法实施例中的显示控制方法。
其中,本申请实施例提供的第一设备、计算机存储介质、计算机程序产品或芯片均用于执行上文所提供的对应的方法,因此,其所能达到的有益效果可参考上文所提供的对应的方法中的有益效果,此处不再赘述。
通过以上实施方式的描述,所属领域的技术人员可以清楚地了解到,为描述的方便和简洁,仅以上述各功能模块的划分进行举例说明,实际应用中,可以根据需要而将上述功能分配由不同的功能模块完成,即将装置的内部结构划分成不同的功能模块,以完成以上描述的全部或者部分功能。
在本申请所提供的几个实施例中,应该理解到,所揭露的装置和方法,可以通过其他的方式实现。例如,以上所描述的装置实施例仅仅是示意性的,例如,模块或单元的划分,仅仅为一种逻辑功能划分,实际实现时可以有另外的划分方式,例如多个单元或组件可以结合或者可以集成到另一个装置,或一些特征可以忽略,或不执行。另一点,所显示或讨论的相互之间的耦合或直接耦合或通信连接可以是通过一些接口,装置或单元的间接耦合或通信连接,可以是电性,机械或其他的形式。
作为分离部件说明的单元可以是或者也可以不是物理上分开的,作为单元显示的部件可以是一个物理单元或多个物理单元,即可以位于一个地方,或者也可以分布到多个不同地方。可以根据实际的需要选择其中的部分或者全部单元来实现本实施例方案的目的。
另外,在本申请各个实施例中的各功能单元可以集成在一个处理单元中,也可以是各个单元单独物理存在,也可以两个或两个以上单元集成在一个单元中。上述集成的单元既可以采用硬件的形式实现,也可以采用软件功能单元的形式实现。
集成的单元如果以软件功能单元的形式实现并作为独立的产品销售或使用时,可以存储在一个可读取存储介质中。基于这样的理解,本申请实施例的技术方案本质上或者说对现有技术做出贡献的部分或者该技术方案的全部或部分可以以软件产品的形式体现出来,该软件产品存储在一个存储介质中,包括若干指令用以使得一个设备(可以是单片机,芯片等)或处理器(processor)执行本申请各个实施例方法的全部或部分步骤。而前述的存储介质包括:U盘、移动硬盘、只读存储器(read only memory,ROM)、随机存取存储器(random access memory,RAM)、磁碟或者光盘等各种可以存储程序代码的介质。
以上内容,仅为本申请的具体实施方式,但本申请的保护范围并不局限于此,任何在本申请揭露的技术范围内的变化或替换,都应涵盖在本申请的保护范围之内。因此,本申请的保护范围应以权利要求的保护范围为准。

Claims (87)

  1. 一种显示控制方法,其特征在于,包括:
    第一设备获取映射信息,所述映射信息包括多个对应关系,所述多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,所述第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,所述连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态或连接态;
    所述第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n等正整数;
    所述第一设备根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。
  2. 根据权利要求1所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述场景信息包括:
    第一工作场景,所述第一设备所在的小区为第一通信系统的小区且支持与第二通信系统的联合组网;或者,
    第二工作场景,所述第一设备通过所述第一通信系统的空口注册在所述第二通信系统的核心网;或者,
    第三工作场景,所述第一设备所在的小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,
    第四工作场景,所述第一设备连接在所述第一通信系统的基站,且所述第一设备具有所述第二通信系统的辅基站。
  3. 根据权利要求2所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述第一设备的工作状态包括:
    所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率,所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率,所述第一设备当前所使用的服务,所述第一设备当前所使用的运营商,所述第一设备当前所在的位置,所述第一设备当前所处的连接状态,或所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景。
  4. 根据权利要求1-3任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述指示信息为所述第一设备从所述第二设备接收到的广播信息。
  5. 根据权利要求1-4任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;
    所述位置信息包括国家代码、省市代码或全球定位系统GPS信息中的至少一种。
  6. 根据权利要求1-5任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述服务类型包括载波聚合CA服务、双连接DC服务或多输入多出MIMO服务中的至少一种。
  7. 根据权利要求1-6任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述第一设备获取映射信息,包括:
    所述第一设备获取所述第一设备上预制的所述映射信息;
    或者,所述第一设备从第三设备获取所述映射信息,所述第三设备与所述第二设备不同。
  8. 根据权利要求7所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述第一设备获取所述第一设备上预制的所述映射信息,包括:
    所述第一设备获取所述第一设备的用户身份识别模块SIM卡中预制的所述映射信息;
    或者,获取所述第一设备的存储器中预制的所述映射信息。
  9. 根据权利要求3-8任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述指示信息和所述频率信息,所述指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于 预设值;
    所述第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    所述第一设备从所述第二设备接收所述指示信息;
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取所述频率信息;
    所述第一设备根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    若所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则所述第一设备显示所述第二通信系统的第一网络图标;
    若所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则所述第一设备显示所述第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
  10. 根据权利要求3-8任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述频率信息和所述场景信息,所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值;
    所述第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取所述频率信息;
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述第一设备根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景或所述第四工作场景时,若所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则所述第一设备显示所述第二通信系统的第一网络图标;
    若所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则所述第一设备显示所述第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
  11. 根据权利要求3-8任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述频率信息、所述连接状态信息和所述场景信息,所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及所述第一设备是否有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,所述低频信号的频率小于预设值,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于所述预设值;
    所述第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率和所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取所述频率信息;
    所述第一设备根据当前所处的连接状态获取所述连接状态信息;
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述第一设备根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若所述连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示第三网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示第四网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系 统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示第五网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示第六网络图标;
    其中,所述第三网络图标、所述第四网络图标、所述第五网络图标和所述第六网络图标可以相同或不同。
  12. 根据权利要求3-8任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述指示信息、所述频率信息、所述连接状态信息和所述场景信息,所述指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及所述第一设备是否有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,所述低频信号的频率小于预设值,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于所述预设值;
    所述第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    所述第一设备从所述第二设备接收所述指示信息;
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率和所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取所述频率信息;
    所述第一设备根据当前所处的连接状态获取所述连接状态信息;
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述第一设备根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    当所述场景信息为所述第一工作场景或所述第二工作场景,所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若所述状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示所述第二通信系统的第七网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示所述第二通信系统的第八网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示所述第二通信系统的第九网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示所述第二通信系统的第十网络图标;
    其中,所述第七网络图标、所述第八网络图标、所述第九网络图标和所述第十网络图标可以相同或不同。
  13. 根据权利要求11或12所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,在所述第一设备获取所述频率信息之前,所述方法还包括:
    所述第一设备获取检测信息,所述检测信息包括第二参数信息,所述第二参数信息包括相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;
    所述第一设备根据所述检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
  14. 根据权利要求13所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,所述第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
  15. 根据权利要求13或14所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述第一设备获取检测信息,包括:
    所述第一设备获取所述第一设备上预制的所述检测信息;
    或者,所述第一设备从所述第三设备获取所述检测信息。
  16. 根据权利要求3-8任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述服务类型和所述场景信息;所述第一设备从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备当前所使用的服务获取所述服务类型;
    所述第一设备根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述第一设备根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景时,若所述服务类型为载波聚合CA服务,则所述第一设备显示第十一网络图标;
    若所述服务类型为双连接DC服务,则所述第一设备显示第十二网络图标;
    若所述服务类型为多入多出MIMO服务,则所述第一设备显示第十三网络图标;
    否则,所述第一设备显示第十四网络图标。
  17. 一种第一设备,其特征在于,包括显示屏、一个或多个处理器和一个或多个存储器;所述显示屏、所述一个或多个存储器与所述一个或多个处理器耦合,所述一个或多个存储器用于存储计算机程序代码,所述计算机程序代码包括计算机指令,当所述一个或多个处理器执行所述计算机指令时,
    所述处理器用于,获取映射信息,所述映射信息包括多个对应关系,所述多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,所述第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,所述连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态或连接态;
    从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n等正整数;
    所述显示屏用于,根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。
  18. 根据权利要求17所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述场景信息包括:
    第一工作场景,所述第一设备所在的小区为第一通信系统的小区且支持与第二通信系统的联合组网;或者,
    第二工作场景,所述第一设备通过所述第一通信系统的空口注册在所述第二通信系统的核心网;或者,
    第三工作场景,所述第一设备所在的小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,
    第四工作场景,所述第一设备连接在所述第一通信系统的基站,且所述第一设备具有所述第二通信系统的辅基站。
  19. 根据权利要求18所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述第一设备的工作状态包括:
    所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率,所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率,所述第一设备当前所使用的服务,所述第一设备当前所使用的运营商,所述第一设备当前所在的位置,所述第一设备当前所处的连接状态,或所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景。
  20. 根据权利要求17-19任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述指示信息为所述第一设备从所述第二设备接收到的广播信息;
    所述运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;
    所述位置信息包括国家代码或省市代码或全球定位系统GPS信息中的至少一种;
    所述服务类型包括载波聚合CA服务、双连接DC服务或多输入多出MIMO服务中的至少一种。
  21. 根据权利要求17-20任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述处理器具体用于:
    获取所述第一设备上预制的所述映射信息;
    或者,从第三设备获取所述映射信息,所述第三设备与所述第二设备不同。
  22. 根据权利要求19-21任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述指示信息和所述频率信息,所述指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值;
    所述处理器具体用于,从所述第二设备接收所述指示信息;
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取所述频率信息;
    所述显示屏具体用于,若所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第一网络图标;
    若所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
  23. 根据权利要求19-21任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述频率信息和所述场景信息,所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值;
    所述处理器具体用于,根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述显示屏具体用于,当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景或所述第四工作场景时,若所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第一网络图标;
    若所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
  24. 根据权利要求19-21任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述频率信息、所述连接状态信息和所述场景信息,所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及所述第一设备是否有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,所述低频信号的频率小于预设值,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于所述预设值;
    所述处理器具体用于,根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率和所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据当前所处的连接状态获取所述连接状态信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述显示屏具体用于,当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若所述连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第三网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第四网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第五网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第六网络图标;
    其中,所述第三网络图标、所述第四网络图标、所述第五网络图标和所述第六网络图标可以相同或不同。
  25. 根据权利要求19-21任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述指示信息、所述频率信息、所述连接状态信息和所述场景信息,所述指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及所述第一设备是否有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,所述低频信号的频率小于预设值,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于所述预设值;
    所述处理器具体用于,从所述第二设备接收所述指示信息;
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率和所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据当前所处的连接状态获取所述连接状态信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述显示屏具体用于,当所述场景信息为所述第一工作场景或所述第二工作场景,所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若所述状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第七网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第八网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第九网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第十网络图标;
    其中,所述第七网络图标、所述第八网络图标、所述第九网络图标和所述第十网络图标可以相同或不同。
  26. 根据权利要求24或25所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述处理器还用于:
    在获取所述频率信息之前,获取检测信息,所述检测信息包括第二参数信息,所述第二参数信息包括相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;
    根据所述检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
  27. 根据权利要求19-21任一项所述的第一设备,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述服务类型和所述场景信息;
    所述处理器具体用于,根据所述第一设备当前所使用的服务获取所述服务类型;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述显示屏具体用于,当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景时,若所述服务类型为载波聚合CA服务,则显示第十一网络图标;
    若所述服务类型为双连接DC服务,则显示第十二网络图标;
    若所述服务类型为多入多出MIMO服务,则显示第十三网络图标;
    否则,显示第十四网络图标。
  28. 一种装置,其特征在于,包括一个或多个处理器和一个或多个存储器;
    所述一个或多个存储器与所述一个或多个处理器耦合,所述一个或多个存储器用于存储计算机程 序代码,所述计算机程序代码包括计算机指令,当所述一个或多个处理器执行所述计算机指令时,使得所述装置执行如权利要求1-16任一项所述的显示控制方法。
  29. 一种计算机存储介质,其特征在于,包括计算机指令,当所述计算机指令在计算机上运行时,使得所述计算机执行如权利要求1-16任一项所述的显示控制方法。
  30. 一种芯片,其特征在于,所述芯片包括处理器,用于支持第一设备实现如权利要求1-16任一项所述的显示控制方法。
  31. 一种显示控制方法,其特征在于,包括:
    第一设备获取检测信息,所述检测信息包括第二参数信息,所述第二参数信息包括所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;
    所述第一设备根据所述检测信息测量所述相邻小区的信号。
  32. 根据权利要求31所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二参数信息包括目标通信系统中相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,目标通信系统中的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
  33. 根据权利要求31或32所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一设备获取检测信息,包括:所述第一设备获取所示第一设备上预制的所述检测信息;或者,所述第一设备从第三设备获取所示检测信息。
  34. 根据权利要求31或32所述的方法,其特征在于,所述检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,所述第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
  35. 根据权利要求31-34任一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;
    位置信息包括国家代码或省市代码或GPS定位信息中的至少一种。
  36. 根据权利要求31-35任一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述测量信息包括小区的频率信息或小区信息。
  37. 根据权利要求31-36任一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述时间信息是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,所示周期信息为所述第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
  38. 根据权利要求31-37任一项所述的方法,其特征在于,所述时间信息应用于定时器,所述时间信息用于以下至少一项:所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在所述定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在获取到所述检测信息后,开启所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在获取到进行信息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启所述定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启所述定时器。
  39. 一种第一设备,其特征在于,包括:
    第一获取单元,用于获取映射信息,所述映射信息包括多个对应关系,所述多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,所述第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,所述连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态或连接态;
    第二获取单元,用于从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n等正整数;
    显示单元,用于根据所述m个第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。
  40. 根据权利要求39所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述场景信息包括:
    第一工作场景,所述第一设备所在的小区为第一通信系统的小区且支持与第二通信系统的联合组网;或者,
    第二工作场景,所述第一设备通过所述第一通信系统的空口注册在所述第二通信系统的核心网;或者,
    第三工作场景,所述第一设备所在的小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,
    第四工作场景,所述第一设备连接在所述第一通信系统的基站,且所述第一设备具有所述第二通信系统的辅基站。
  41. 根据权利要求40所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述第一设备的工作状态包括:
    所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率,所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率,所述第一设备当前所使用的服务,所述第一设备当前所使用的运营商,所述第一设备当前所在的位置,所述第一设备当前所处的连接状态,或所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景。
  42. 根据权利要求39-41任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述指示信息为所述第一设备从所述第二设备接收到的广播信息。
  43. 根据权利要求39-42任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;
    所述位置信息包括国家代码、省市代码或全球定位系统GPS信息中的至少一种。
  44. 根据权利要求39-43任一项所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述服务类型包括载波聚合CA服务、双连接DC服务或多输入多出MIMO服务中的至少一种。
  45. 根据权利要求39-44任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述第一获取单元具体用于:
    获取所述第一设备上预制的所述映射信息;
    或者,从第三设备获取所述映射信息,所述第三设备与所述第二设备不同。
  46. 根据权利要求45所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述第一获取单元具体用于:
    获取所述第一设备的用户身份识别模块SIM卡中预制的所述映射信息;
    或者,获取所述第一设备的存储器中预制的所述映射信息。
  47. 根据权利要求41-46任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述指示信息和所述频率信息,所述指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值;
    所述第二获取单元具体用于:
    从所述第二设备接收所述指示信息;
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取所述频率信息;
    所述显示单元具体用于:
    若所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第一网络图标;
    若所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
  48. 根据权利要求41-46任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所 述频率信息和所述场景信息,所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值;
    所述第二获取单元具体用于:
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述显示单元具体用于:
    若所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景或所述第四工作场景时,若所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第一网络图标;
    若所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
  49. 根据权利要求41-46任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述频率信息、所述连接状态信息和所述场景信息,所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及所述第一设备是否有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,所述低频信号的频率小于预设值,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于所述预设值;
    所述第二获取单元具体用于:
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率和所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据当前所处的连接状态获取所述连接状态信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述显示单元具体用于:
    当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若所述连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第三网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则所述第一设备显示第四网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第五网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第六网络图标;
    其中,所述第三网络图标、所述第四网络图标、所述第五网络图标和所述第六网络图标可以相同或不同。
  50. 根据权利要求41-46任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述指示信息、所述频率信息、所述连接状态信息和所述场景信息,所述指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及所述第一设备是否有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,所述低频信号的频率小于预设值,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于所述预设值;
    所述第二获取单元具体用于:
    从所述第二设备接收所述指示信息;
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率和所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取所 述频率信息;
    根据当前所处的连接状态获取所述连接状态信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述显示单元具体用于:
    当所述场景信息为所述第一工作场景或所述第二工作场景,所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若所述状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第七网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第八网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第九网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第十网络图标;
    其中,所述第七网络图标、所述第八网络图标、所述第九网络图标和所述第十网络图标可以相同或不同。
  51. 根据权利要求48-50任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述第一设备还包括第三获取单元和测量单元,
    所述第三获取单元用于,在第二获取单元获取频率信息之前获取检测信息,所述检测信息包括第二参数信息,所述第二参数信息包括相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;
    所述检测单元用于,根据所述检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
  52. 根据权利要求51所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,所述第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
  53. 根据权利要求51或52所述的第一设备,其特征在于,第三获取单元具体用于:
    获取所述第一设备上预制的所述检测信息;
    或者,从所述第三设备获取所述检测信息。
  54. 根据权利要求41-45任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述服务类型和所述场景信息;所述第二获取单元具体用于:
    根据所述第一设备当前所使用的服务获取所述服务类型;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    所述显示单元具体用于:当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景时,若所述服务类型为载波聚合CA服务,则显示第十一网络图标;
    若所述服务类型为双连接DC服务,则显示第十二网络图标;
    若所述服务类型为多入多出MIMO服务,则显示第十三网络图标;
    否则,显示第十四网络图标。
  55. 根据权利要求51所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述第二参数信息包括第二通信系统的小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
  56. 根据权利要求51-53任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述检测信息还包括包括小区的频 率信息或小区信息。
  57. 根据权利要求51-53任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述时间信息是所述第一设备进行测量的周期信息,所述周期信息为所述第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
  58. 根据权利要求51-53任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述时间信息应用于定时器,所述时间信息用于以下至少一项:所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在所述定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在发生小区重选时,重置或停止或取消所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在接收到所述第二设备发送的所述第二消息后,开启所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在接收到所述第二设备发送的所述第二消息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启所述定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启所述定时器。
  59. 根据权利要求41-45任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个第一参数信息包括场景信息;所述第二获取单元具体用于:根据所示第一设备当前所处的所述工作场景获取所述场景信息;所述显示单元具体用于:当所述场景信息为所述第二工作场景时,显示所述第二通信系统的所述第二网络图标。
  60. 根据权利要求39-59任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述第一通信系统为4G系统,所述第二通信系统为5G系统。
  61. 一种电子设备,包括:检测单元,用于获取检测信息,检测信息包括第二参数信息,第二参数信息包括第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;
    测量单元,用于根据检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
  62. 根据权利要求61所述的电子设备,其特征在于,所述第二参数信息包括目标通信系统中相邻小区的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;和/或,目标通信系统中的相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种,高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值。
  63. 根据权利要求61或62所述的电子设备,其特征在于,
    所述获取单元具体用于:获取所述第一设备上预制的检测信息;或者,从第三设备获取检测信息。
  64. 根据权利要求61-63任一项所述的电子设备,其特征在于,所述检测信息还包括所述第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,所述第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
  65. 根据权利要求61-64任一项所述的电子设备,其特征在于,所述运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;所述位置信息包括国家代码或省市代码或GPS定位信息中的至少一种。
  66. 根据权利要求61-65任一项所述的电子设备,其特征在于,所述测量信息包括小区的频率信息或小区信息。
  67. 根据权利要求61-66任一项所述的电子设备,其特征在于,所述时间信息是第一设备进行测量的周期信息,所述周期信息为第一设备进行相邻两次测量时,第一次测量的开始时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔,或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的开始时间之间的间隔;或者第一次测量的结束时间与第二次测量的结束时间之间的间隔。
  68. 根据权利要求67所述的电子设备,其特征在于,所述时间信息应用于定时器,所述时间信息用于以下至少一项:所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在定时器超时时进行测量,并开启或重启所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在结束测量时,开启或重启所述定时器;或者,所述时 间信息用于所述第一设备在获取到所述检测信息后,开启所述定时器;或者,所述时间信息用于所述第一设备在获取到进行信息后进行测量,并在开始测量时开启或重启所述定时器,或者在结束测量时开启或重启所述定时器。
  69. 一种第一设备,包括显示屏、一个或多个处理器和一个或多个存储器;显示屏、一个或多个存储器与一个或多个处理器耦合,一个或多个存储器用于存储计算机程序代码,计算机程序代码包括计算机指令,当一个或多个处理器执行计算机指令时,使得所述第一设备执行:
    获取映射信息,所述映射信息包括多个对应关系,所述多个对应关系用于表示n个第一参数信息与多个网络图标的对应关系,n为正整数,所述第一参数信息包括指示信息,频率信息,服务类型,运营商信息,位置信息,连接状态信息,或场景信息,所述连接状态信息包括空闲态,非激活态或连接态;
    从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,m为小于或者等于n等正整数;
    根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标。
  70. 根据权利要求69所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述场景信息包括:
    第一工作场景,所述第一设备所在的小区为第一通信系统的小区且支持与第二通信系统的联合组网;或者,
    第二工作场景,所述第一设备通过所述第一通信系统的空口注册在所述第二通信系统的核心网;或者,
    第三工作场景,所述第一设备所在的小区为第二通信系统的小区;或者,
    第四工作场景,所述第一设备连接在所述第一通信系统的基站,且所述第一设备具有所述第二通信系统的辅基站。
  71. 根据权利要求70所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述第一设备的工作状态包括:
    所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率,所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率,所述第一设备当前所使用的服务,所述第一设备当前所使用的运营商,所述第一设备当前所在的位置,所述第一设备当前所处的连接状态,或所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景。
  72. 根据权利要求69-71任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述指示信息为所述第一设备从所述第二设备接收到的广播信息。
  73. 根据权利要求69-72任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述运营商信息包括公共陆地移动网络PLMN标识;
    所述位置信息包括国家代码、省市代码或全球定位系统GPS信息中的至少一种。
  74. 根据权利要求69-73任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述服务类型包括载波聚合CA服务、双连接DC服务或多输入多出MIMO服务中的至少一种。
  75. 根据权利要求69-74任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述获取映射信息,包括:
    获取所述第一设备上预制的所述映射信息;
    或者,从第三设备获取所述映射信息,所述第三设备与所述第二设备不同。
  76. 根据权利要求75所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述获取所述第一设备上预制的所述映射信息,包括:
    获取所述第一设备的用户身份识别模块SIM卡中预制的所述映射信息;
    或者,获取所述第一设备的存储器中预制的所述映射信息。
  77. 根据权利要求72-76任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述指示信息和所述频率信息,所述指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值;
    所述从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    从所述第二设备接收所述指示信息;
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    若所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第一网络图标;
    若所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
  78. 根据权利要求72-76任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述频率信息和所述场景信息,所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率是否为高频信号,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于预设值;
    所述从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景或所述第四工作场景时,若所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第一网络图标;
    若所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率不是高频信号,则显示所述第二通信系统的第二网络图标。
  79. 根据权利要求72-76任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述频率信息、所述连接状态信息和所述场景信息,所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及所述第一设备是否有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,所述低频信号的频率小于预设值,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于所述预设值;
    从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率和所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据当前所处的连接状态获取所述连接状态信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若所述连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第三网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第四网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系 统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第五网络图标;
    若所述连接状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示第六网络图标;
    其中,所述第三网络图标、所述第四网络图标、所述第五网络图标和所述第六网络图标可以相同或不同。
  80. 根据权利要求72-76任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述指示信息、所述频率信息、所述连接状态信息和所述场景信息,所述指示信息用于指示是否显示第二通信系统的网络图标;所述频率信息用于表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号,以及所述第一设备是否有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,所述低频信号的频率小于预设值,所述高频信号的频率大于或者等于所述预设值;
    从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    从所述第二设备接收所述指示信息;
    根据所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率和所述第一设备所在小区的相邻小区的信号的频率获取所述频率信息;
    根据当前所处的连接状态获取所述连接状态信息;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    当所述场景信息为所述第一工作场景或所述第二工作场景,所述指示信息指示显示所述第二通信系统的网络图标,所述频率信息表示所述第一设备所在小区的服务频率为低频信号时,若所述状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第七网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为空闲态或非激活态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第八网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备有所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第九网络图标;
    若所述状态信息为连接态,且所述频率信息表示所述第一设备无所述第二通信系统同运营商的相邻小区的高频信号覆盖,则显示所述第二通信系统的第十网络图标;
    其中,所述第七网络图标、所述第八网络图标、所述第九网络图标和所述第十网络图标可以相同或不同。
  81. 根据权利要求72-76任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,在所述获取所述频率信息之前,所述第一设备还执行:
    获取检测信息,所述检测信息包括第二参数信息,所述第二参数信息包括相邻小区的高频信号的测量信息或时间信息中的至少一种;
    根据所述检测信息测量相邻小区的信号。
  82. 根据权利要求81所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述检测信息还包括第二参数信息与至少一个第三参数信息的对应关系,所述第三参数信息包括运营商信息或位置信息。
  83. 根据权利要求81或82所述的显示控制方法,其特征在于,所述获取检测信息,包括:
    获取所述第一设备上预制的所述检测信息;
    或者,从所述第三设备获取所述检测信息。
  84. 根据权利要求72-77任一项所述的第一设备,其特征在于,所述m个所述第一参数信息包括所述服务类型和所述场景信息;所述从第二设备获取和/或根据所述第一设备的工作状态获取m个所述第一参数信息,包括:
    根据所述第一设备当前所使用的服务获取所述服务类型;
    根据所述第一设备当前所处的工作场景获取所述场景信息;
    根据m个所述第一参数信息与网络图标的对应关系显示网络图标,包括:
    当所述场景信息为所述第三工作场景时,若所述服务类型为载波聚合CA服务,则显示第十一网络图标;
    若所述服务类型为双连接DC服务,则显示第十二网络图标;
    若所述服务类型为多入多出MIMO服务,则显示第十三网络图标;
    否则,所述第一设备显示第十四网络图标。
  85. 一种电子设备,包括一个或多个处理器和一个或多个存储器;显示屏、一个或多个存储器与一个或多个处理器耦合,一个或多个存储器用于存储计算机程序代码,计算机程序代码包括计算机指令,当一个或多个处理器执行计算机指令时,使得所述电子设备执行如权利要求31-38任一项所述的显示控制方法。
  86. 一种计算机存储介质,其特征在于,包括计算机指令,当所述计算机指令在计算机上运行时,使得所述计算机执行如权利要求31-38任一项所述的显示控制方法。
  87. 一种芯片,其特征在于,所述芯片包括处理器,用于支持第一设备实现如权利要求31-38任一项所述的显示控制方法。
PCT/CN2019/100907 2018-08-17 2019-08-16 一种显示控制方法及设备 WO2020035041A1 (zh)

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
CN201810939827.7A CN110839106B (zh) 2018-08-17 2018-08-17 一种显示控制方法及设备
CN201810939827.7 2018-08-17

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2020035041A1 true WO2020035041A1 (zh) 2020-02-20

Family

ID=69524681

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/CN2019/100907 WO2020035041A1 (zh) 2018-08-17 2019-08-16 一种显示控制方法及设备

Country Status (2)

Country Link
CN (1) CN110839106B (zh)
WO (1) WO2020035041A1 (zh)

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN117119512A (zh) * 2023-04-07 2023-11-24 荣耀终端有限公司 图标显示控制方法及装置

Families Citing this family (8)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN111246543B (zh) * 2020-03-20 2021-08-03 捷开通讯(深圳)有限公司 图标显示方法、装置、存储介质及电子终端
CN115484670A (zh) * 2020-03-25 2022-12-16 荣耀终端有限公司 一种网络图标的显示方法及终端
CN111465070B (zh) * 2020-04-21 2021-06-15 捷开通讯(深圳)有限公司 一种实现5g信号平稳显示的方法
CN113692068B (zh) * 2020-05-19 2023-09-22 成都鼎桥通信技术有限公司 终端信号测量方法和系统
CN111787562A (zh) * 2020-06-22 2020-10-16 捷开通讯(深圳)有限公司 图标显示方法、装置、存储介质及电子终端
CN112540708A (zh) * 2020-12-17 2021-03-23 中国联合网络通信集团有限公司 网络信息显示方法及装置、电子设备及存储介质
CN112714434B (zh) * 2020-12-25 2022-10-11 北京小米移动软件有限公司 标识显示方法及装置、电子设备、计算机可读存储介质
CN113316171B (zh) * 2021-05-13 2022-09-02 Tcl通讯(宁波)有限公司 5g图标显示控制方法、装置、终端设备及存储介质

Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN101331782A (zh) * 2006-11-13 2008-12-24 捷讯研究有限公司 用于显示无线模式指示符的系统、方法和移动设备
CN101772219A (zh) * 2010-01-19 2010-07-07 深圳市同洲电子股份有限公司 传输移动通信终端无线模式信息的方法及移动通信终端
CN106134167A (zh) * 2014-03-19 2016-11-16 微软技术许可有限责任公司 混合电信网络连接指示符
CN106454876A (zh) * 2015-08-07 2017-02-22 中国电信股份有限公司 用于灵活带宽的小区测量方法、系统以及设备
CN108064453A (zh) * 2017-09-27 2018-05-22 深圳前海达闼云端智能科技有限公司 邻区配置的方法、装置和存储介质

Family Cites Families (10)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN102611512A (zh) * 2012-01-18 2012-07-25 华为技术有限公司 一种信号信息的显示装置及移动设备
WO2014166099A1 (zh) * 2013-04-12 2014-10-16 华为技术有限公司 一种小区测量的方法、用户设备和无线通信节点
CN105917729A (zh) * 2014-01-23 2016-08-31 宇龙计算机通信科技(深圳)有限公司 信号状态的显示方法和显示装置、终端
EP2958375B1 (en) * 2014-06-13 2018-12-05 HTC Corporation Method and apparatus for handling device to device communication in a wireless communication system
CN104244466B (zh) * 2014-09-28 2018-03-16 宇龙计算机通信科技(深圳)有限公司 一种终端及网络状态显示方法
CN105933518B (zh) * 2016-04-21 2019-06-25 Oppo广东移动通信有限公司 一种运营商图标显示方法及移动终端
CN106792869B (zh) * 2016-08-12 2019-01-29 展讯通信(上海)有限公司 测量配置方法及装置、基站
CN108235828B (zh) * 2016-10-13 2020-12-04 华为技术有限公司 一种终端设备的搜网显示的方法、装置和终端设备
CN107396337A (zh) * 2017-07-14 2017-11-24 深圳天珑无线科技有限公司 网络图标显示方法、移动终端及计算机可读存储介质
CN107734493A (zh) * 2017-09-30 2018-02-23 努比亚技术有限公司 一种主屏显示规则适配方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质

Patent Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN101331782A (zh) * 2006-11-13 2008-12-24 捷讯研究有限公司 用于显示无线模式指示符的系统、方法和移动设备
CN101772219A (zh) * 2010-01-19 2010-07-07 深圳市同洲电子股份有限公司 传输移动通信终端无线模式信息的方法及移动通信终端
CN106134167A (zh) * 2014-03-19 2016-11-16 微软技术许可有限责任公司 混合电信网络连接指示符
CN106454876A (zh) * 2015-08-07 2017-02-22 中国电信股份有限公司 用于灵活带宽的小区测量方法、系统以及设备
CN108064453A (zh) * 2017-09-27 2018-05-22 深圳前海达闼云端智能科技有限公司 邻区配置的方法、装置和存储介质

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN117119512A (zh) * 2023-04-07 2023-11-24 荣耀终端有限公司 图标显示控制方法及装置

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
CN110839106A (zh) 2020-02-25
CN110839106B (zh) 2021-07-09

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
WO2020035041A1 (zh) 一种显示控制方法及设备
US9769739B2 (en) Cell discovery method and device
CN107690828B (zh) 自主lte-wlan接口设置和信息交换
CN102422678B (zh) 无线电通信系统中用于支持dtx的方法和设备
TWI568283B (zh) 管理共存干擾之方法和裝置、來源無線電接取節點、目標無線電接取節點、以及包含程式碼手段之電腦程式
US11540185B2 (en) ULI cell selection prioritization
CN111034258B (zh) 无线设备、网络节点及其执行的用于处理对小区集合的测量的方法
US20170318523A1 (en) Communication device and method therein for selecting cell and radio access technology in wireless communication network
EP4068657A1 (en) Sidelink relay pathloss estimation in wireless communication
EP3031247B1 (en) Terminal and method for inter rat access selection in a communications network
TW202031066A (zh) 換手方法及使用者設備
WO2018000439A1 (zh) 无线通信的方法和装置
WO2018089930A1 (en) Systems, methods, and devices for high speed cell identification
US20170086055A1 (en) Improving device to device communication
US20150365893A1 (en) Wireless communication apparatus and communication system
CN104363624A (zh) 无线电通信系统中用于支持dtx的方法和设备
CN106470457B (zh) 一种能力指示方法、路由建立方法、移动终端及网络设备
CN112218288B (zh) 一种通信方法和装置
CN115835314A (zh) 测量、测量配置方法、装置、终端及网络侧设备
CN114258058A (zh) 测量方法、测量装置、终端及网络设备
CN115835397B (zh) 用于无线通信的方法及装置
GB2512356A (en) Methods and apparatuses enabling selection between cellular and non-cellular radio connections
WO2024065429A1 (zh) 一种通信方法、终端设备以及网络设备
CN114223238B (zh) 一种通信方法与装置
US20240284425A1 (en) Method and apparatus for wireless communication

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 19849247

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

122 Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase

Ref document number: 19849247

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1